AVR-2808

Transcription

AVR-2808
AV SURROUND RECEIVER
AVR-2808
Owner’s Manual
Bedienungsanleitung
Manuel de l’Utilisateur
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
1
v Book 1
English
Deutsch Français PRESET CODE
Book 2
Italiano
Español
Nederlands Svenska
2007/09/28
11:40:06
ENGLISH
DEUTSCH FRANCAIS ITALIANO ESPAÑOL NEDERLANDS SVENSKA
nSAFETY PRECAUTIONS
CAUTION
RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK
DO NOT OPEN
CAUTION:
TO REDUCE THE RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, DO NOT REMOVE
COVER (OR BACK). NO USER-SERVICEABLE PARTS INSIDE.
REFER SERVICING TO QUALIFIED SERVICE PERSONNEL.
The lightning flash with arrowhead symbol, within an equilateral
triangle, is intended to alert the user to the presence of
uninsulated “dangerous voltage” within the product’s enclosure
that may be of sufficient magnitude to constitute a risk of electric
shock to persons.
The exclamation point within an equilateral triangle is intended
to alert the user to the presence of important operating
and maintenance (servicing) instructions in the literature
accompanying the appliance.
WARNING:
TO REDUCE THE RISK OF FIRE OR ELECTRIC SHOCK, DO NOT
EXPOSE THIS APPLIANCE TO RAIN OR MOISTURE.
• DECLARATION OF CONFORMITY
We declare under our sole responsibility that this product, to which this
declaration relates, is in conformity with the following standards:
EN60065, EN55013, EN55020, EN61000-3-2 and EN61000-3-3.
Following the provisions of 2006/95/EC, 89/336/EEC and 93/68/EEC
Directive.
• ÜBEREINSTIMMUNGSERKLÄRUNG
CAUTION:
To completely disconnect this product from the mains, disconnect
the plug from the wall socket outlet.
The mains plug is used to completely interrupt the power supply to
the unit and must be within easy access by the user.
VORSICHT:
Wir erklären unter unserer Verantwortung, daß dieses Produkt, auf das
sich diese Erklärung bezieht, den folgenden Standards entspricht:
EN60065, EN55013, EN55020, EN61000-3-2 und EN61000-3-3.
Entspricht den Verordnungen der Direktive 2006/95/EC, 89/336/EEC und
93/68/EEC.
Um dieses Gerät vollständig von der Stromversorgung abzutrennen,
ziehen Sie bitte den Stecker aus der Wandsteckdose.
Der Netzstecker wird verwendet, um die Stromversorgung zum
Gerät völlig zu unterbrechen; er muss für den Benutzer gut und
einfach zu erreichen sein.
• DECLARATION DE CONFORMITE
PRECAUTION:
Nous déclarons sous notre seule responsabilité que l’appareil, auquel se
réfère cette déclaration, est conforme aux standards suivants:
EN60065, EN55013, EN55020, EN61000-3-2 et EN61000-3-3.
D’après les dispositions de la Directive 2006/95/EC, 89/336/EEC et 93/68/
EEC.
• DICHIARAZIONE DI CONFORMITÀ
Pour déconnecter complètement ce produit du courant secteur,
débranchez la prise de la prise murale.
La prise secteur est utilisée pour couper complètement
l’alimentation de l’appareil et l’utilisateur doit pouvoir y accéder
facilement.
Dichiariamo con piena responsabilità che questo prodotto, al quale la
nostra dichiarazione si riferisce, è conforme alle seguenti normative:
EN60065, EN55013, EN55020, EN61000-3-2 e EN61000-3-3.
In conformità con le condizioni delle direttive 2006/95/EC, 89/336/EEC e
93/68/EEC.
QUESTO PRODOTTO E’ CONFORME
AL D.M. 28/08/95 N. 548
ATTENZIONE:
Per scollegare completamente questo prodotto dalla rete di
alimentazione elettrica, scollegare la spina dalla relativa presa a muro.
La spina di rete viene utilizzata per interrompere completamente
l’alimentazione all’unità e deve essere facilmente accessibile
all’utente.
• DECLARACIÓN DE CONFORMIDAD
PRECAUCIÓN:
Declaramos bajo nuestra exclusiva responsabilidad que este producto al
que hace referencia esta declaración, está conforme con los siguientes
estándares:
EN60065, EN55013, EN55020, EN61000-3-2 y EN61000-3-3.
Siguiendo las provisiones de las Directivas 2006/95/EC, 89/336/EEC y
93/68/EEC.
• EENVORMIGHEIDSVERKLARING
Wij verklaren uitsluitend op onze verantwoordelijkheid dat dit produkt,
waarop deze verklaring betrekking heeft, in overeenstemming is met de
volgende normen:
EN60065, EN55013, EN55020, EN61000-3-2 en EN61000-3-3.
Volgens de bepalingen van de Richtlijnen 2006/95/EC, 89/336/EEC en
93/68/EEC.
• ÖVERENSSTÄMMELSESINTYG
Härmed intygas helt på eget ansvar att denna produkt, vilken detta intyg
avser, uppfyller följande standarder:
EN60065, EN55013, EN55020, EN61000-3-2 och EN61000-3-3.
Enligt stadgarna i direktiv 2006/95/EC, 89/336/EEC och 93/68/EEC.
Para desconectar completamente este producto de la alimentación
eléctrica, desconecte el enchufe del enchufe de la pared.
El enchufe de la alimentación eléctrica se utiliza para interrumpir por
completo el suministro de alimentación eléctrica a la unidad y debe
de encontrarse en un lugar al que el usuario tenga fácil acceso.
WAARSCHUWING:
Om de voeding van dit product volledig te onderbreken moet de
stekker uit het stopcontact worden getrokken.
De netstekker wordt gebruikt om de stroomtoevoer naar het toestel
volledig te onderbreken en moet voor de gebruiker gemakkelijk
bereikbaar zijn.
FÖRSIKTIHETSMÅTT:
Koppla loss stickproppen från eluttaget för att helt skilja produkten
från nätet.
Stickproppen används för att helt bryta strömförsörjningen till
apparaten, och den måste vara lättillgänglig för användaren.
I
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
2
2007/09/28
11:40:07
SVENSKA NEDERLANDS ESPAÑOL ITALIANO FRANCAIS DEUTSCH ENGLISH
nNOTE ON USE / HINWEISE ZUM GEBRAUCH / OBSERVATIONS RELATIVES A L’UTILISATION / NOTE SULL’USO /
NOTAS SOBRE EL USO / ALVORENS TE GEBRUIKEN / OBSERVERA ANGÅENDE ANVÄNDNINGEN
CAUTION:
•The ventilation should not be impeded by covering the ventilation openings with items,
such as newspapers, tablecloths, curtains, etc.
• No naked flame sources, such as lighted candles, should be placed on the unit.
• Observe and follow local regulations regarding battery disposal.
• Do not expose the unit to dripping or splashing fluids.
• Do not place objects filled with liquids, such as vases, on the unit.
ACHTUNG:
• Do not let foreign objects into the unit.
• Keep the unit free from moisture, water, and dust.
• Lassen Sie keine fremden Gegenstände in das Gerät kommen.
•
Halten
Sie
das
Gerät
von
Feuchtigkeit,
Wasser
und
Staub
• Ne pas laisser des objets étrangers dans l’appareil.
• Avoid high temperatures.
fern.
• Non inserite corpi estranei all’interno dell’unità.
Allow for sufficient heat dispersion when installed in a rack.
• Protéger l’appareil contre l’humidité, l’eau et la poussière.
• No deje objetos extraños dentro del equipo.
• Vermeiden Sie hohe Temperaturen.
Beachten Sie, dass eine ausreichende Belüftung gewährleistet • Tenete l’unità lontana dall’umidità, dall’acqua e dalla • Laat geen vreemde voorwerpen in dit apparaat vallen.
polvere.
• Se till att främmande föremål inte tränger in i apparaten.
wird, wenn das Gerät auf ein Regal gestellt wird.
• Mantenga el equipo libre de humedad, agua y polvo.
• Eviter des températures élevées.
•
Laat
geen
vochtigheid,
water
of
stof
in
het
apparaat
Tenir compte d’une dispersion de chaleur suffisante lors de
binnendringen.
l’installation sur une étagère.
• Utsätt inte apparaten för fukt, vatten och damm.
• Evitate di esporre l’unità a temperature elevate.
Assicuratevi che vi sia un’adeguata dispersione del calore
quando installate l’unità in un mobile per componenti audio.
• Evite altas temperaturas.
Permite la suficiente dispersión del calor cuando está
instalado en la consola.
• Vermijd hoge temperaturen.
Zorg er bij installatie in een audiorack voor, dat de door
• Do not let insecticides, benzene, and thinner come in
het toestel geproduceerde warmte goed kan worden
contact with the unit.
afgevoerd.
• Lassen Sie das Gerät nicht mit Insektiziden, Benzin oder
• Unplug the power cord when not using the unit for long
• Undvik höga temperaturer.
Verdünnungsmitteln in Berührung kommen.
periods of time.
Se till att det finns möjlighet till god värmeavledning vid
• Ne pas mettre en contact des insecticides, du benzène et
• Wenn das Gerät längere Zeit nicht verwendet werden soll,
montering i ett rack.
un diluant avec l’appareil.
trennen Sie das Netzkabel vom Netzstecker.
• Assicuratevi che l’unità non entri in contatto con insetticidi,
• Débrancher le cordon d’alimentation lorsque l’appareil n’est
benzolo o solventi.
pas utilisé pendant de longues périodes.
• No permita el contacto de insecticidas, gasolina y diluyentes
• Scollegate il cavo di alimentazione quando prevedete di non
con el equipo.
utilizzare l’unità per un lungo periodo di tempo.
• Voorkom dat insecticiden, benzeen of verfverdunner met dit
• Desconecte el cordón de energía cuando no utilice el equipo
toestel in contact komen.
por mucho tiempo.
• Se till att inte insektsmedel på spraybruk, bensen och
• Neem altijd het netsnoer uit het stopkontakt wanneer het
thinner kommer i kontakt med apparatens hölje.
apparaat gedurende een lange periode niet wordt gebruikt.
• Koppla loss nätkabeln om apparaten inte kommer att
användas i lång tid.
• Handle the power cord carefully.
Hold the plug when unplugging the cord.
• Gehen Sie vorsichtig mit dem Netzkabel um.
Halten Sie das Kabel am Stecker, wenn Sie den Stecker
herausziehen.
• Manipuler le cordon d’alimentation avec précaution.
Tenir la prise lors du débranchement du cordon.
• Manneggiate il cavo di alimentazione con attenzione.
Tenete ferma la spina quando scollegate il cavo dalla presa.
• Never disassemble or modify the unit in any way.
* (For apparatuses with ventilation holes)
• Maneje el cordón de energía con cuidado.
• Versuchen Sie niemals das Gerät auseinander zu nehmen
Sostenga el enchufe cuando desconecte el cordón de • Do not obstruct the ventilation holes.
oder zu verändern.
energía.
• Ne jamais démonter ou modifier l’appareil d’une manière ou
• Decken Sie den Lüftungsbereich nicht ab.
• Hanteer het netsnoer voorzichtig.
d’une autre.
• Ne pas obstruer les trous d’aération.
Houd het snoer bij de stekker vast wanneer deze moet • Non coprite i fori di ventilazione.
• Non smontate né modificate l’unità in alcun modo.
worden aan- of losgekoppeld.
• Nunca desarme o modifique el equipo de ninguna manera.
• No obstruya los orificios de ventilación.
• Hantera nätkabeln varsamt.
• Dit toestel mag niet gedemonteerd of aangepast worden.
• De ventilatieopeningen mogen niet worden beblokkeerd.
Håll i kabeln när den kopplas från el-uttaget.
• Ta inte isär apparaten och försök inte bygga om den.
• Täpp inte till ventilationsöppningarna.
•Die Belüftung sollte auf keinen Fall durch das Abdecken der Belüftungsöffnungen durch
Gegenstände wie beispielsweise Zeitungen, Tischtücher, Vorhänge o. Ä. behindert
werden.
•Auf dem Gerät sollten keinerlei direkte Feuerquellen wie beispielsweise angezündete
Kerzen aufgestellt werden.
•Bitte beachten Sie bei der Entsorgung der Batterien die örtlich geltenden
Umweltbestimmungen.
•Das Gerät sollte keiner tropfenden oder spritzenden Flüssigkeit ausgesetzt werden.
•Auf dem Gerät sollten keine mit Flüssigkeit gefüllten Behälter wie beispielsweise Vasen
aufgestellt werden.
ATTENTION:
•La ventilation ne doit pas être gênée en recouvrant les ouvertures de la ventilation avec des
objets tels que journaux, rideaux, tissus, etc.
• Aucune flamme nue, par exemple une bougie, ne doit être placée sur l’appareil.
• Veillez à respecter les lois en vigueur lorsque vous jetez les piles usagées.
• L’appareil ne doit pas être exposé à l’eau ou à l’humidité.
• Ne pas poser d’objet contenant du liquide, par exemple un vase, sur l’appareil.
ATTENZIONE:
•Le aperture di ventilazione non devono essere ostruite coprendole con oggetti, quali
giornali, tovaglie, tende e così via.
• Non posizionate sull’unità fiamme libere, come ad esempio candele accese.
•Prestate attenzione agli aspetti legati alla tutela dell’ambiente nello smaltimento delle
batterie.
• L’apparecchiatura non deve essere esposta a gocciolii o spruzzi.
•Non posizionate sull’unità alcun oggetto contenente liquidi, come ad esempio i vasi.
PRECAUCIÓN:
•La ventilación no debe quedar obstruida por haberse cubierto las aperturas con objetos
como periódicos, manteles, cortinas, etc.
•No debe colocarse sobre el aparato ninguna fuente inflamable sin protección, como velas
encendidas.
•A la hora de deshacerse de las pilas, respete la normativa para el cuidado del medio
ambiente.
• No exponer el aparato al goteo o salpicaduras cuando se utilice.
• No colocar sobre el aparato objetos llenos de líquido, como jarros.
WAARSCHUWING:
•De ventilatie mag niet worden belemmerd door de ventilatieopeningen af te dekken met
bijvoorbeeld kranten, een tafelkleed, gordijnen, enz.
• Plaats geen open vlammen, bijvoorbeeld een brandende kaars, op het apparaat.
• Houd u steeds aan de milieuvoorschriften wanneer u gebruikte batterijen wegdoet.
• Stel het apparaat niet bloot aan druppels of spatten.
• Plaats geen voorwerpen gevuld met water, bijvoorbeeld een vaas, op het apparaat.
OBSERVERA:
•Ventilationen bör inte förhindras genom att täcka för ventilationsöppningarna med föremål
såsom tidningar, bordsdukar, gardiner osv.
• Inga blottade brandkällor, såsom tända ljus, får placeras på apparaten.
• Tänk på miljöaspekterna när du bortskaffar batterier.
• Apparaten får inte utsättas för vätska.
• Placera inte föremål fyllda med vätska, t.ex. vaser, på apparaten.
II
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
3
2007/09/28
11:40:08
ENGLISH
DEUTSCH FRANCAIS ITALIANO ESPAÑOL NEDERLANDS SVENSKA
A NOTE ABOUT RECYCLING:
This product’s packaging materials are recyclable and can be reused. Please dispose of any materials
in accordance with the local recycling regulations.
When discarding the unit, comply with local rules or regulations.
Batteries should never be thrown away or incinerated but disposed of in accordance with the local
regulations concerning battery disposal.
This product and the supplied accessories, excluding the batteries, constitute the applicable product
according to the WEEE directive.
HINWEIS ZUM RECYCLING:
Das Verpackungsmaterial dieses Produktes ist zum Recyceln geeignet und kann wieder verwendet werden. Bitte
entsorgen Sie alle Materialien entsprechend der örtlichen Recycling-Vorschriften.
Beachten Sie bei der Entsorgung des Gerätes die örtlichen Vorschriften und Bestimmungen.
Die Batterien dürfen nicht in den Hausmüll geworfen oder verbrannt werden; bitte entsorgen Sie die Batterien gemäß
der örtlichen Vorschriften.
Dieses Produkt und das im Lieferumfang enthaltene Zubehör (mit Ausnahme der Batterien!) entsprechen der WEEEDirektive.
UNE REMARQUE CONCERNANT LE RECYCLAGE:
Les matériaux d’emballage de ce produit sont recyclables et peuvent être réutilisés. Veuillez disposer des matériaux
conformément aux lois sur le recyclage en vigueur.
Lorsque vous mettez cet appareil au rebut, respectez les lois ou réglementations en vigueur.
Les piles ne doivent jamais être jetées ou incinérées, mais mises au rebut conformément aux lois en vigueur sur la
mise au rebut des piles.
Ce produit et les accessoires inclus, à l’exception des piles, sont des produits conformes à la directive DEEE.
NOTA RELATIVA AL RICICLAGGIO:
I materiali di imballaggio di questo prodotto sono riutilizzabili e riciclabili. Smaltire i materiali conformemente alle
normative locali sul riciclaggio.
Per lo smaltimento dell’unità, osservare le normative o le leggi locali in vigore.
Non gettare le batterie, né incenerirle, ma smaltirle conformemente alla normativa locale sui rifiuti chimici.
Questo prodotto e gli accessori inclusi nell’imballaggio sono applicabili alla direttiva RAEE, ad eccezione delle batterie.
ACERCA DEL RECICLAJE:
Los materiales de embalaje de este producto son reciclables y se pueden volver a utilizar. Disponga de estos materiales
siguiendo los reglamentos de reciclaje de su localidad.
Cuando se deshaga de la unidad, cumpla con las reglas o reglamentos locales.
Las pilas nunca deberán tirarse ni incinerarse. Deberá disponer de ellas siguiendo los reglamentos de su localidad
relacionados con los desperdicios químicos.
Este producto junto con los accesorios empaquetados es el producto aplicable a la directiva RAEE excepto pilas.
EEN AANTEKENING MET BETREKKING TOT DE RECYCLING:
Het inpakmateriaal van dit product is recycleerbaar en kan opnieuw gebruikt worden. Er wordt verzocht om zich van elk
afvalmateriaal te ontdoen volgens de plaatselijke voorschriften.
Volg voor het wegdoen van de speler de voorschriften voor de verwijdering van wit- en bruingoed op.
Batterijen mogen nooit worden weggegooid of verbrand, maar moeten volgens de plaatselijke voorschriften betreffende
chemisch afval worden verwijderd.
Op dit product en de meegeleverde accessoires, m.u.v. de batterijen is de richtlijn voor afgedankte elektrische en
elektronische apparaten (WEEE) van toepassing.
OBSERVERA ANGÅENDE ÅTERVINNING:
Produktens emballage är återvinningsbart och kan återanvändas. Kassera det enligt lokala återvinningsbestämmelser.
När du kasserar enheten ska du göra det i överensstämmelse med lokala regler och bestämmelser.
Batterier får absolut inte kastas i soporna eller brännas. Kassera dem enligt lokala bestämmelser för kemiskt avfall.
Denna apparat och de tillbehör som levereras med den uppfyller gällande WEEE-direktiv, med undantag av
batterierna.
III
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
4
2007/09/28
11:40:09
ENGLISH
Contents
Getting Started
Accessories·······················································································2
Cautions on Handling······································································3
Cautions on Installation··································································3
About the Remote Control Unit·····················································3
Inserting the Batteries·····································································3
Operating Range of the Remote Control Unit·································3
Part Names and Functions······························································4
Front Panel······················································································4
Display····························································································4
Rear Panel·······················································································5
Remote Control Unit·······································································6
Connections
Preparations·····················································································7
Cables Used for Connections·························································7
Video Conversion Function······························································8
On-Screen Display for Component Video Outputs and
HDMI Output··················································································8
Speaker Connections······································································9
Speaker Installation·········································································9
Speaker Connections································································ 9, 10
Connecting Equipment with HDMI connectors·························· 11
Connecting the Monitor································································ 12
Connecting the Playback Components······································· 12
DVD Player···················································································· 12
Record Player················································································ 13
CD Player······················································································ 13
iPod®····························································································· 14
TV/CABLE Tuner············································································ 14
Satellite Receiver·········································································· 15
Connecting the Recording Components····································· 15
Digital Video Recorder··································································· 15
Video Cassette Recorder······························································ 16
CD Recorder / MD Recorder / Tape Deck······································ 16
Connections to Other Devices······················································ 17
Video Camera / Game Console····················································· 17
Component with Multi-channel Output connectors······················ 17
External Power Amplifier······························································· 17
Antenna terminals · ······································································ 18
Multi-zone····················································································· 19
External Controller········································································ 19
Connecting the Power Cord·························································20
Once Connections are Completed···············································20
Menu Operations
Operations······················································································20
Example of Display of Default Values··········································21
Examples of On-screen Display and Front Display·····················21
Menu Map······················································································22
Auto Setup
Preparations···················································································23
Auto Setup·····················································································24
a Start Menu···············································································24
Error Messages········································································25
s Option······················································································25
d Parameter Check······································································25
Manual Setup
Speaker Setup···············································································26
a Speaker Configuration······························································26
s Subwoofer Setup·····································································26
d Distance·············································································26, 27
f Channel Level··········································································27
g Crossover Frequency·······························································27
HDMI Setup····················································································27
a HDMI Audio Setup···································································27
s HDMI Video Setup···································································28
Audio Setup···················································································28
a EXT. IN Subwoofer Level··························································28
s 2ch Direct/Stereo·······························································28, 29
d Dolby Digital Setup··································································29
f Auto Surround Mode·······························································29
g Manual EQ···············································································29
Zone Setup·····················································································30
a ZONE2 Setup···········································································30
s ZONE3 Setup···········································································30
Option Setup··················································································31
a Amp Assign··············································································31
s Volume Control········································································31
d Source Delete··········································································31
f On-Screen Display·····························································31, 32
g Quick Select Name··································································32
h Trigger Out···············································································32
j Remote ID Setup·····································································32
k 2Way Remote··········································································32
l Display·····················································································32
A0 Setup Lock···············································································33
Input Setup
Settings Related to Playing Input Sources··································34
Auto Preset···················································································34
Preset Skip····················································································34
Preset Name·················································································34
Input Mode···················································································34
Rename·························································································34
Assign···························································································35
iPod·························································································35, 36
Other·····························································································36
Surround Modes
Standard Playback·········································································36
Surround Playback of 2-channel Sources······································36
Playing Multi-channel Sources (Dolby Digital, DTS, etc.)··············37
DSP Simulation Playback·····························································37
Stereo Playback·············································································37
Direct Playback··············································································37
Playback in the PURE DIRECT Mode············································38
Parameter
a Surround Parameter···························································38 ~ 40
s Tone Control···············································································40
d Room EQ····················································································40
f RESTORER·················································································41
g Night Mode················································································41
h Audio Delay················································································41
Information
Status·····························································································41
a Main Zone················································································41
s ZONE2 / ZONE3·······································································41
Audio Input Signal·········································································42
HDMI Information··········································································42
a HDMI Signal Information·························································42
s HDMI Monitor Information······················································42
Auto Surround Mode·····································································42
Quick Select···················································································42
Preset Station················································································42
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
5
2007/09/28
11:40:09
ENGLISH
Getting Started
Connections
Setup
Playback
Remote Control
Playback
Preparations···················································································43
Turning the Power On···································································43
Selecting the Input Source····························································43
Operations During Playback··························································43
Playing Video and Audio Equipment············································44
Basic Operation·············································································44
Listening to FM/AM Broadcasts··················································44
Basic Operation·············································································44
Presetting Radio Stations (Preset Memory)··································44
Listening to Preset Stations··························································45
RDS (Radio Data System)·····························································45
RDS Search···················································································45
PTY Search····················································································46
TP Search······················································································46
RT (Radio Text)···············································································47
iPod® Playback··············································································47
Basic Operation·············································································47
Listening to Music···································································47, 48
Viewing Still Pictures or Videos on the iPod··································48
Multi-Zone
Information
Troubleshooting
Other Operations and Functions
Other Operations···········································································48
Playing Super Audio CD································································48
Recording on an External Device (REC OUT mode)······················49
Convenient Functions···································································49
Channel Level················································································49
Fader Function··············································································49
Quick Select Function···································································50
Personal Memory Plus Function···················································50
Last Function Memory··································································50
Backup Memory············································································50
Resetting the Microprocessor·······················································50
Remote Control Unit Operations
Main Remote Control Unit···························································51
Operating DENON Audio Components·········································51
Presetting······················································································51
Operating Preset Components·············································51 ~ 53
Setting the Remote ID··································································54
Learning Function··········································································54
System Call Function·····································································55
Punch Through Function································································55
Setting the Time the Backlight Stays Lit········································55
Adjusting the Backlight’s Brightness·············································55
Resetting the Main Remote Control Unit······································56
Sub Remote Control Unit·····························································57
Amp Assign / Multi-zone Connections and Operations
Multi-zone Settings with the Amp Assign Function··········57 ~ 59
Multi-zone Settings and Operations with Zone Pre-out Output·····59
Multi-zone Operations··································································60
Turning the Power On and Off······················································60
Selecting the Input Source····························································60
Adjusting the Volume····································································60
Turning off the Sound Temporarily·················································60
Other Information·································································61 ~ 69
Troubleshooting······································································ 70, 71
Getting Started
Thank you for purchasing this DENON product. To ensure proper
operation, please read this owner’s manual carefully before using the
product.
After reading them, be sure to keep them for future reference.
Accessories
Check that the following parts are supplied with the product.
qOwner’s manual....................................................................... 1
wService station list.................................................................... 1
ePower cord (Cord length: Approx. 1.5 m).................................. 1
rMain remote control (RC-1068)................................................ 1
tLR6/AA batteries (for RC-1068)................................................. 2
ySub remote control (RC-1071).................................................. 1
uR03/AAA batteries (for RC-1071).............................................. 2
iFM indoor antenna................................................................... 1
oAM loop antenna...................................................................... 1
Q0Setup microphone (Cord length: Approx. 7.6 m)....................... 1
e
r
y
i
o
Q0
Specifications················································································ 72
List of preset codes············································ End of this manual
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
6
2007/09/28
11:40:10
ENGLISH
About the Remote Control Unit
•Before turning the power switch on
Check once again that all connections are correct and that there are
no problems with the connection cables.
Inserting the Batteries
q Lift the clasp and remove the rear lid.
(RC-1068)
(RC-1071)
(RC-1068)
Point the remote control unit at the remote sensor when operating it.
(RC-1071)
R03/AAA
LR6/AA
(RC-1071)
30°
e Put the rear cover back on.
Troubleshooting
Note:
For proper heat dispersal, do not install this unit in a confined
space, such as a bookcase or similar enclosure.
30°
or
Approx. 7 m
bNote
b
(RC-1068)
b
Information
Cautions on Installation
Multi-Zone
•Note that the illustrations in these instructions may differ from the
actual unit for explanation purposes.
w Load the two batteries properly as indicated by the marks in the
battery compartment.
Operating Range of the Remote Control
Unit
Remote Control
•Moving the unit
Turn off the power and unplug the power cord from the power
outlet.
Next, disconnect the connection cables to other system units before
moving the unit.
Playback
•Cautions on using mobile phones
Using a mobile phone near this unit may result in noise. If so, move
the mobile phone away from this unit when it is in use.
Setup
•About condensation
If there is a major difference in temperature between the inside of
the unit and the surroundings, condensation (dew) may form on
the operating parts inside the unit, causing the unit not to operate
properly.
If this happens, let the unit sit for an hour or two with the power
turned off and wait until there is little difference in temperature
before using the unit.
Connections
•Power is supplied to some of the circuitry even when the unit is
set to the standby mode. When traveling or leaving home for long
periods of time, be sure to unplug the power cord from the power
outlet.
In addition to the AVR-2808, the included main remote control unit
(RC-1068) can also be used to operate the equipment listed below.
qDENON system components
wNon-DENON system components
•By setting the preset memory (vpage 51 ~ 53)
•By using the learn function (vpage 54)
NOTE
•Replace the batteries with new ones if the set does not operate even
when the remote control unit is operated close to the unit.
•The supplied batteries are only for verifying operation.
•When inserting the batteries, be sure to do so in the proper direction,
following the “q” and “w” marks in the battery compartment.
•To prevent damage or leakage of battery fluid:
•Do not use a new battery together with an old one.
•Do not use two different types of batteries.
•Do not attempt to charge dry batteries.
•Do not short-circuit, disassemble, heat or dispose of batteries in
flames.
•If the battery fluid should leak, carefully wipe the fluid off the inside
of the battery compartment and insert new batteries.
•Remove the batteries from the remote control unit if it will not be in
use for long periods.
•When replacing the batteries, have the new batteries ready and
insert them as quickly as possible.
Getting Started
Cautions on Handling
NOTE
The set may function improperly or the remote control unit may not
operate if the remote control sensor is exposed to direct sunlight,
strong artificial light from an inverter type fluorescent lamp or infrared
light.
b
Wall
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
7
2007/09/28
11:40:11
ENGLISH
Getting Started
Part Names and Functions
Display
For buttons not explained here, see the page indicated in parentheses ( ).
Q7
Front Panel
Connections
o
i
u
y
Q6
Q5
Q4
Q3
Q2
Q1 o
Q0
i
u
y
t
Setup
Playback
q
Q0 Q1 Q2
w
qInput signal indicators
wInput signal channel indicators
Q3
Remote Control
Multi-Zone
q
w e
r
GWith the door openH
E4 E3 E2 E1 E0 W9
W8 W7 W6 W5 W4 W3
Information
Troubleshooting
Q4 Q5 Q6 Q7 Q8 Q9
W0 W1
W2
qPower operation button
(ON/STANDBY)············································ (43)
wPower indicator············································ (43)
ePower switch (hON jOFF)······················ (43)
rQUICK SELECT buttons / indicators·········· (50)
tMASTER VOLUME control knob················· (43)
yMaster volume indicator
uDisplay
iRemote control sensor·································· (3)
oSOURCE SELECT knob······························· (43)
Q0SOURCE button··········································· (43)
Q1TUNING PRESET button····························· (45)
Q2ZONE2/3 / REC SELECT button··········· (49, 60)
Q3VIDEO SELECT button································ (36)
Q4Headphones jack (PHONES)······················· (43)
Q5ZONE2 ON/OFF button······························· (60)
Q6ZONE3 ON/OFF button······························· (60)
Q7INPUT MODE button··································· (34)
Q8MENU button··············································· (20)
Q9Cursor buttons (uio p)··························· (20)
W0CH SEL / ENTER button························ (20, 49)
W1RETURN button··········································· (20)
W2V.AUX INPUT connectors···························· (17)
W3SETUP MIC jack··········································· (23)
W4ROOM EQ button········································· (40)
W5DIMMER button··········································· (32)
W6SPEAKER button·········································· (43)
W7SURROUND BACK button·························· (40)
W8STATUS button············································ (42)
W9AUDIO DELAY button·································· (41)
E0RESTORER button······································· (41)
E1DIRECT/STEREO button····························· (37)
E2PURE DIRECT button··································· (38)
E3DSP SIMULATION button··························· (37)
E4STANDARD button······································ (36)
The input source name, surround mode, setting
values and other information are displayed here.
rOutput signal channel indicators
tFront speaker indicator
These light according to the settings of the front
A and B speakers.
yHDMI monitor indicator
This lights when an HDMI monitor is detected.
This lights when the REC OUT mode is
selected.
Q0NIGHT indicator
This lights when the night mode is selected.
Q1Multi-zone indicators
These light when the power for the respective
zone is turned on.
when
playing
using
HDMI
These light when the respective decoders are
operating.
Q7Tuner reception mode indicators
This lights
connections.
Q6Decoder indicators
This lights when the room equalizer is selected.
This lights when AL24 Processing Plus is
activated (vpage 63).
Q4Input mode indicators
Q5HDMI indicator
uMaster volume indicator
iAUDYSSEY MULTEQ XT indicator
oRecording output source indicator
r t
Q3AL24 indicator
These light when digital signals are input.
eInformation display
e
These light according to the reception conditions
when the input source is set to “TUNER”.
•AUTO
This lights when in the auto tuning mode.
•RDS
This lights when receiving RDS broadcasts.
•STEREO
In the FM mode, this lights when receiving
analog stereo broadcasts.
•TUNED
This lights when the broadcast is properly tuned
in.
Q2RESTORER indicator
This lights when the RESTORER mode is
selected.
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
8
2007/09/28
11:40:12
ENGLISH
Q1
Q2
Q0
Getting Started
Rear Panel
o
Connections
Setup
Playback
Q3
Q3
Q6
Remote Control
Q5
Q5
Q4
Multi-Zone
Information
w
e
qRS-232C connector······································ (19)
wREMOTE CONTROL jacks··························· (19)
eTRIGGER OUT jacks···································· (19)
rDOCK CONTROL jack·································· (14)
tSpeaker terminals (SPEAKERS)··················· (9)
ySIGNAL GND terminal································ (13)
r
t
uAC inlet (AC IN)············································ (20)
iAC OUTLET·················································· (20)
oDigital audio connectors
y
u
Troubleshooting
q
i
Q2VIDEO / S-VIDEO connectors····················· (12)
Q3Analog audio connectors (AUDIO)············· (12)
Q4FM/AM antenna terminals
(OPTICAL / COAXIAL)··························· (12, 15)
(TUNER ANTENNA)····································· (18)
Q0COMPONENT VIDEO connectors··············· (12)
Q1HDMI connectors··········································(11)
Q5PRE OUT connectors······························ (17, 19)
Q6EXT. IN connectors······································ (17)
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
9
2007/09/28
11:40:15
ENGLISH
Getting Started
Remote Control Unit
nMain remote control unit (RC-1068)
Q5
Connections
q
Setup
w
Q6
Q7
Playback
e
r
Remote Control
Multi-Zone
t
y
u
i
Q8
Q9
o
W2
W0
W1
Information
Q0
W3
Q1
W4
Q2
Troubleshooting
Q3
W5
W6
Q4
W7
nSub remote control unit (RC-1071)
qSignal transmission indicator···················· (51)
wMode select buttons··································· (51)
eQuick select / System call buttons······ (50, 55)
rSurround mode buttons·····················(36 ~ 38)
tSystem buttons····································· (52, 53)
yAudio delay button (A. DL)························· (41)
uTuner system buttons································· (44)
iInput mode button (INPUT)························ (34)
oMENU button··············································· (20)
Q0Cursor buttons (uio p)·························· (20)
Q1Parameter / Search button
(PARA / SRCH)······································· (38, 48)
Q2HOME button··············································· (51)
Q3Channel buttons (CH)·································· (44)
Q4Input source select / Number buttons··· (43, 44)
Q5Remote control signal transmitter··············· (3)
Q6Device select indicators (DEV1 / DEV2)···· (51)
Q7ZONE3 select indicators (Z3)······················ (51)
Q8RESTORER button (RSTR)··························· (41)
Q9Night button (NGT)····································· (41)
W0Test tone button (TEST)······························ (27)
W1Front speaker select button (SPKR)··········· (43)
W2POWER buttons··········································· (43)
W3Channel select (CH SEL) /
ENTER button········································ (20, 49)
W4Return button (RTN)···································· (20)
W5Master volume control buttons (VOL)······· (43)
W6Muting button (MUTE)·························· (43, 60)
W7Main remote control unit setup button
(RC SETUP)·················································· (51)
The time for which the backlight stays on can
be changed (vpage 55 “Setting the Time the
Backlight Stays Lit”).
q
i
w
o
NOTE
•The M. SEL, SAT TU, DTU, NET/USB buttons
cannot be used.
•The ZONE2 mode QUICK SELECT (1 ~ 3), A. DL,
RSTR, NGT, INPUT, SPKR, TEST and surround
mode buttons cannot be used.
•The ZONE4 mode cannot be used.
Q0
Q1
e
r
t
Q2
Q3
y
u
qRemote control signal transmitter··············· (3)
wZone power off button (OFF)······················ (60)
eCHANNEL buttons······································· (57)
rTUNING buttons·········································· (57)
tSystem buttons··········································· (57)
yREPEAT button············································· (57)
uRANDOM button········································· (57)
iZONE2/ZONE3 select switch······················ (57)
oZone power on button (ON)······················· (60)
Q0Input source select buttons························ (60)
Q1Volume control buttons (VOLUME)··········· (60)
Q2Muting button (MUTE)································ (60)
Q3SHIFT button················································ (57)
The FAVORITES DIRECT PLAY button is for future
use.
NOTE
The SAT TU and DTU buttons cannot be used.
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
10
2007/09/28
11:40:16
ENGLISH
Connections
Cables Used for Connections
Select the cables according to the equipment being connected.
Audio cables
Component video connections
(Green)
(Orange)
Coaxial digital (75 Ω/ohms pin-plug) cable
(Red)
(PR/CR)
Component video cable
S-Video connections
Optical cable
(White)
L
L
(Red)
R
R
S-Video cable
Video connections
(Yellow)
Multi-Zone
Stereo pin-plug cable
75 Ω/ohms pin-plug video cable
Analog connections (monaural, for subwoofer)
(Black)
Audio and video cables
Information
Pin-plug cable
Remote Control
Analog connections (stereo)
(PB/CB)
Playback
Optical digital connections
(Y)
(Blue)
Setup
•Do not plug in the power cord until all connections have been
completed.
•When making connections, also refer to the operating instructions of
the other components.
•Be sure to connect the left and right channels properly (left with left,
right with right).
•Do not bundle power cords together with connection cables. Doing
so can result in humming or noise.
Video cables
Coaxial digital connections
NOTE
Connections
Connections for all compatible audio and video signal formats are
described in these operating instructions. Please select the types
of connections suited for the equipment you are connecting.
With some types of connections, certain settings must be made
on the AVR-2808. For details, refer to the instructions for the
respective connection items below.
Getting Started
Preparations
HDMI connections
Speaker connections
Speaker cables
Troubleshooting
19-pin HDMI cable
Signal direction
Audio signal:
Video signal:
Output
Input
Input
Output Output
Input
Input
Output
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
11
2007/09/28
11:40:17
ENGLISH
Getting Started
Video Conversion Function
Connections
•This function automatically converts various formats of video signals input to the AVR-2808 into the
format used to output the video signals from the AVR-2808 to a monitor.
•The AVR-2808’s video input/output circuitry is compatible with the following four types of video signals:
Digital video signals: HDMI
Analog video signals: Component video, S-Video and Video
GFlow of video signals inside the AVR-2808H
Setup
HDMI connector
Component video
connectors
Component video
connectors
S-Video connector
S-Video connector
Video connector
Video connector
Video inputs
Video outputs
Playback
HDMI connector
NOTE
•HDMI signals cannot be converted into analog signals.
•1080p component input video signals cannot be output to anything other than component video
connectors.
•480p/576p, 1080i and 720p component video input signals cannot be converted into S-Video or Video
format.
•When a non-standard video signal from a game machine or some other source is input, the video
conversion function might not operate.
Main zone
High picture
quality playback
•When not using this function, connect a monitor output with the same type of connector as the video
input connector.
•The resolution of the HDMI input-compatible monitor connected to the AVR-2808 can be checked at
menu “Information” – “HDMI Information” (vpage 42).
Remote Control
Monitor
On-Screen Display for Component Video Outputs and HDMI
Output
Multi-Zone
•When viewing HDMI or component video signals via the AVR-2808, the on-screen display appears when
the MENU button or the main remote control unit´s PARA button is operated.
•When only HDMI or component video signals are input to the AVR-2808, the characters of the on-screen
display are not displayed over the picture.
Information
: When 480i/576i signals are input in the main zone
GFlow of video signals for ZONE2H
Troubleshooting
ZONE2
High picture
quality playback
ZONE2
monitor
S-Video connector
Video connector
Video connector
Video inputs
Video outputs
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
12
2007/09/28
11:40:18
ENGLISH
Speaker Connections
Getting Started
Speaker Connections
Example: 7.1-channels (FRONT A+B)
Speaker Installation
Front speakers
A
Front speakers
B
Center speaker
Subwoofer
(L)
w
(R)
q
w
(L)
q
w
(R)
q
w
q
w
q
*/
Setup
Subwoofer
with built-in
amplifier
Surround back speakers
Connections
The illustration below shows a basic example of installation of the amplifier combined with 8 speakers and
a monitor.
Subwoofer
Center speaker
Playback
Remote Control
Multi-Zone
Front speakers
Place the front speakers to the
sides of the monitor or screen and
as flush with the screen surface as
possible.
Surround speakers
Information
The table below shows a typical speaker configuration for the AVR-2808.
7.1-channels
(FRONT A+B)
7.1-channels
6.1-channels
5.1-channels
3.1-channels
2.1-channels
2-channels
CENTER
SURROUND
L
R
SURROUND BACK
SUBWOOFER
L
R
1 only
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
–
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
–
–
S
S
S
–
–
–
S
S
S
–
–
–
S
–
–
–
–
–
S
–
–
–
–
–
–
S
–
–
–
–
S
S
S
S
S
–
bL : Left
R : Right
(L)
w
(R)
qw
(L)
q
Surround speakers
w
Troubleshooting
FRONT
L
R
(R)
qw
q
Surround back speakers
When using just one surround back speaker, connect it to the left channel (SBL).
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
13
2007/09/28
11:40:21
ENGLISH
Getting Started
Connecting the Speaker Cables
Carefully check the left (L) and right (R) channels and + (red) and –
(black) polarities on the speakers being connected to the AVR-2808,
and be sure to interconnect the channels and polarities correctly.
Connections
1
Peel off about 10 mm of sheathing from
Setup
Playback
Remote Control
2
3
4
the tip of the speaker cable, then either
twist the core wire tightly or terminate
it.
Turn
the
speaker
terminal
counterclockwise to loosen it.
Insert the speaker cable’s core wire to
Protection circuit
If speakers with an impedance lower than specified (for example
4 Ω/ohms speakers) are used for an extended period of time with
the volume turned up high, the temperature may rise, activating the
protection circuit.
When the protection circuit is activated, the speaker output is shut
off and the power indicator flashes red. If this happens, unplug
the power cord, then check the speaker cable and input cable
connections. If the set is extremely hot, wait for it to cool off and
improve ventilation around it. Once this is done, plug the power cord
back in and turn the set’s power back on.
If the protection circuit is activated again even though there are no
problems in the ventilation around the set nor in the connections,
the set may be damaged. Turn the power off, then contact a DENON
service center.
the hilt into the speaker terminal.
Turn the speaker terminal clockwise to
tighten it.
NOTE
Multi-Zone
Information
•Use speakers with an impedance of 6 to 16 Ω/ohms. When using
front A and B speakers simultaneously, use speakers with an
impedance of 8 to 16 Ω/ohms.
•Connect the speaker cables in such a way that they do not stick out
of the speaker terminals. The protection circuit may be activated if
the core wires touch the rear panel or if the + and – sides touch each
other (v “Protection circuit”).
•Never touch the speaker terminals while the power supply is
connected. Doing so could result in electric shock.
Troubleshooting
10
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
14
2007/09/28
11:40:22
ENGLISH
NOTE
With HDMI connections, the video and audio signals can be transferred with a single cable.
Monitor
)%.*
065
)%.*
*/
bThe AVR-2808 is equipped for HDMI version 1.3a. This
version is compatible with other versions, allowing
connection to all components equipped with an HDMI
connector.
bThe AVR-2808 is compatible with 30- and 36-bit Deep
Color.
Details
Discs
(examples)
2ch 32-192 kHz
16/20/24 bits
CD, DVD-Video,
DVD-Audio
Multi-channel
linear PCM
8ch 32-192 kHz
16/20/24 bits
DVD-Audio
DSD
2/5.1ch
2.8224 MHz
1 bit
SACD
HD DVD,
Blu-ray Disc
•When the AVR-2808 and DVD player are connected using an HDMI cable, also connect the AVR-2808 and
monitor using an HDMI cable.
•If the connected monitor or DVD player only has a DVI-D connector, use an HDMI/DVI converter cable.
When using a DVI cable, no audio signals are transmitted.
•Use a Deep Color compatible cable for connection to Deep Color compatible devices.
When connecting with an HDMI/DVI converter cable (adapter)
Copyright protection system (HDCP)
Information
Troubleshooting
In order to play the digital video and audio signals of a DVDVideo or DVD-Audio disc using HDMI/DVI connections, both
the connected DVD player and monitor must be equipped
for a copyright protection system called “HDCP” (Highbandwidth Digital Content Protection).
HDCP is a copy protection technology consisting of data
encoding and mutual identification of the devices.
The AVR-2808 is HDCP-compatible. For details on the
DVD player or monitor you are using, refer to its operating
instructions.
•HDMI video signals are theoretically compatible with the DVI format.
When connecting to a monitor, etc., equipped with a DVI-D connector, connection is possible using an
HDMI/DVI converter cable, but depending on the combination of components in some cases the video
signals will not be output.
•When connecting using an HDMI/DVI converter adapter, the video signals may not be output properly
due to poor connections with the connected cable, etc.
Multi-Zone
Dolby Digital Plus,
Dolby TrueHD,
Bitstream
DTS-HD
DVD-Video
Remote Control
Dolby Digital, DTS Bitstream
Playback
2-channel linear
PCM
Setup
Compatible
audio format
Connections
DVD player
•Use a CPPM-compatible DVD player to play DVD-Audio discs that are copyright-protected by CPPM.
•The AVR-2808 cannot be controlled from another device via the HDMI cable.
•The audio signals output from the HDMI connector (sampling frequency, bit rate, etc.) may be restricted
by the connected device.
•Video signals are not output properly when using devices that are not HDCP-compatible.
•Video signals are not output if the input video signals do not match the monitor’s resolution. In this case,
switch the DVD player’s resolution to a resolution with which the monitor is compatible.
•If the menu “Manual Setup” – “HDMI Setup” – “HDMI Audio Setup” – “HDMI Audio Out” setting
(vpage 27) is set to “AMP”, the sound may be interrupted when the monitor’s power is turned off.
•Use a cable on which the HDMI logo is indicated (a certified HDMI product) for connection to the HDMI
connector. Normal playback may not be possible when using a cable other than one on which the HDMI
logo is indicated (a non-HDMI-certified product).
•If the monitor or DVD player does not support deep color, deep color signal transfer is not possible.
•If the monitor or DVD player does not support xvYCC, xvYCC signal transfer is not possible.
•If the monitor does not support “Auto Lipsync Correction” function, this function will not work.
Getting Started
Connecting Equipment with HDMI connectors
•By default, the HDMI audio signals are output from the speakers connected to the AVR-2808.
•To output the sound from the TV, make the settings at menu “Manual Setup” – “HDMI Setup” – “HDMI
Audio Setup” – “HDMI Audio Out” – “TV” (vpage 27).
11
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
15
2007/09/28
11:40:23
ENGLISH
Getting Started
Connecting the Monitor
Connecting the Playback Components
•Connect the cables to be used (vpage 8 “Video Conversion Function”).
•With HDMI connections, the video and audio signals can be transferred with a single cable.
•To output the audio signals to the monitor with HDMI connections, set menu “Manual Setup” – “HDMI
Setup” – “HDMI Audio Setup” – “HDMI Audio Out” to “TV” (vpage 27).
Connections
Monitor
7*%&0
)%.*
*/
7*%&0
*/
47*%&0
*/
$0.10/&/57*%&0
*/
:
1# 13
Carefully check the left (L) and right (R) channels and the inputs and outputs, and be sure to interconnect
correctly.
DVD Player
•Connect the cables to be used.
•With HDMI connections, the video and audio signals can be transferred with a single cable.
DVD player
Setup
7*%&0
)%.*
065
7*%&0
065
47*%&0
065
$0.10/&/57*%&0
065
:
1# 13
"6%*0
"6%*0
065
3
Playback
Remote Control
L
R
L
R
$0"9*"065
Multi-Zone
Information
Troubleshooting
NOTE
•The component video connectors may be indicated differently on your monitor. For details, see the
monitor’s operating instructions.
•The audio signals output from the HDMI connectors are only the HDMI input signals.
•Connect an HDP (High-Definition Player) in the same way.
•When using an optical cable for the digital audio connection, make the settings at menu “Input Setup”
– “Assign” – “Digital In” (vpage 35).
12
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
16
2007/09/28
11:40:28
ENGLISH
CD Player
Turntable (MM cartridge)
Getting Started
Record Player
Connect the cables to be used.
CD player
"6%*0
L
R
L
R
Setup
"6%*0
065
$0"9*"065
Connections
"6%*0
065
3
(/%
L
R
Playback
Remote Control
Multi-Zone
Information
Troubleshooting
•When connecting a record player with an MC cartridge, use a
commercially available MC head amplifier or a step-up transformer.
•Induction humming (a booming sound) may be produced from the
speakers if the volume is raised with no record player connected.
•With some record players, noise may be generated when the ground
wire is connected. If so, disconnect the ground wire.
When using an optical cable for the digital audio connection, make
the settings at menu “Input Setup” – “Assign” – “Digital In” (vpage
35).
NOTE
The AVR-2808’s SIGNAL GND terminal is meant to reduce noise when
a record player is connected. This is not a safety ground terminal.
13
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
17
2007/09/28
11:40:31
ENGLISH
Getting Started
iPod®
TV/CABLE Tuner
Use a DENON Control Dock for iPod (ASD-1R, sold separately) to connect the iPod to the AVR-2808.
For instructions on the Control Dock for iPod settings, refer to the Control Dock for iPod’s operating
instructions.
Connect the cables to be used.
TV tuner
7*%&0
Connections
7*%&0
065
iPod
"4%3
47*%&0
065
$0.10/&/57*%&0
065
:
1# 13
"6%*0
"6%*0
065
3
R
L
R
Setup
L
$0"9*"065
Playback
Remote Control
R
L
R
L
Multi-Zone
Information
Troubleshooting
When using an optical cable for the digital audio connection, make the settings at menu “Input Setup”
– “Assign” – “Digital In” (vpage 35).
•With the default settings, the iPod can be used connected to the VCR (iPod) connector.
•To assign the iPod to a connector other than VCR (iPod), make the settings at menu “Input Setup” –
“(input source to which iPod dock assigned)” – “Assign” – “iPod dock” (vpage 35).
14
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
18
2007/09/28
11:40:35
ENGLISH
Carefully check the left (L) and right (R) channels and the inputs and outputs, and be sure to interconnect
correctly.
Connect the cables to be used.
DBS / BS tuner
7*%&0
47*%&0
065
"6%*0
"6%*0
065
3
015*$"065
Digital Video Recorder
Connections
7*%&0
065
Connect the cables to be used.
Digital video recorder
7*%&0
L
R
"6%*0
"6%*0
*/
-
065
*/
Playback
L
3
015*$"065
3
Setup
47*%&0
*/
065
7*%&0
065
*/
R
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
or
Remote Control
L
Getting Started
Connecting the Recording Components
Satellite Receiver
or
Multi-Zone
Information
Troubleshooting
•When using a coaxial digital cable for the digital audio connection, make the settings at menu “Input
Setup” – “Assign” – “Digital In” (vpage 35).
•When using a component video cable for the video connection, make the settings at menu “Input Setup”
– “Assign” – “Component In” (vpage 35).
•Make analog connections if you wish to record analog audio signals.
•When recording via the AVR-2808, the playback device´s cable must be of the same type as the cable
used to connect the AVR-2808´s DVR OUT connector.
Example: TV IN → S-Video cable : DVR OUT → S-Video cable
TV IN → Video cable : DVR OUT → Video cable
•When using a component video cable for the video connection, make the settings at menu “Input Setup”
– “Assign” – “Component In” (vpage 35).
NOTE
Do not connect the output of the component connected to the AVR-2808’s OPTICAL2 output connector to
any input connector other than OPTICAL2.
15
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
19
2007/09/28
11:40:41
ENGLISH
Getting Started
Video Cassette Recorder
CD Recorder / MD Recorder / Tape Deck
Connect the cables to be used.
Make analog connections if you wish to record analog audio signals, or digital connections if you wish to
record digital audio signals, depending on the types of connectors on the components being used.
Video cassette recorder
7*%&0
Connections
CD recorder /
MD recorder / Tape deck
"6%*0
47*%&0
*/
065
7*%&0
065
*/
"6%*0
*/
-
3
015*$"065
3
065
*/
"6%*0
"6%*0
065
3
L
R
L
015*$"*/
-
065
*/
3
R
Setup
Playback
or
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
or
L
R
L
R
or
Remote Control
Multi-Zone
Information
Troubleshooting
•When recording via the AVR-2808, the playback device´s cable must be of the same type as the cable
used to connect the AVR-2808´s VCR OUT connector.
Example: TV IN → S-Video cable : VCR OUT → S-Video cable
TV IN → Video cable : VCR OUT → Video cable
•When using a component video cable for the video connection, make the settings at menu “Input Setup”
– “Assign” – “Component In” (vpage 35).
NOTE
Do not connect the output of the component connected to the AVR-2808’s OPTICAL3 output connector to
any input connector other than OPTICAL3.
NOTE
Do not connect the output of the component connected to the AVR-2808’s OPTICAL3 output connector to
any input connector other than OPTICAL3.
16
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
20
2007/09/28
11:40:46
ENGLISH
Carefully check the left (L) and right (R) channels and the inputs and
outputs, and be sure to interconnect correctly.
Video camera / Game console
7*%&0
7*%&0
065
"6%*0
065
3
'30/5
-
463306/%
-
3
3
$&/5&3
463306/%
-
3
463306/%
#"$,
-
3
463306/%
#"$,
-
3
L
R
L
R
L
R
R
L
R
L
L
R
L
R
L
R
R
Playback
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
Remote Control
L
'30/5
015*$"065
L
L
3
$&/5&3
"6%*0
46#
800'&3
-
"6%*0
46#
800'&3
Power amplifier
Setup
47*%&0
065
"6%*0
DVD player /
Super Audio CD player / External decoder
External Power Amplifier
Connections
Video Camera / Game Console
Component with Multi-channel Output
connectors
Getting Started
Connections to Other Devices
R
Multi-Zone
Information
Troubleshooting
•To play the analog input signals input to the EXT. IN connectors, press
the INPUT MODE button on the main unit or INPUT button on the
main remote control unit and select “EXT. IN” or make the settings
at menu “Input Setup” – “Input Mode” – “Input Mode” – “EXT. IN”
(vpage 34).
•The video signal can be connected in the same way as a DVD player
(vpage 12).
•To play copyright-protected discs, connect the AVR-2808’s EXT.
IN connector with the DVD player’s analog multi-channel output
connector.
When using just one surround back speaker, connect it to the left
channel (SBL).
17
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
21
2007/09/28
11:40:51
ENGLISH
Getting Started
Antenna terminals
An FM antenna cable plug can be connected directly.
Direction of broadcasting station
Connections
AM loop antenna
(supplied)
FM antenna
Setup
Playback
75 Ω/ohms
Coaxial cable
Remote Control
FM indoor antenna
(supplied)
Multi-Zone
Information
Ground
AM outdoor antenna
Troubleshooting
AM loop antenna assembly
Connect to the AM
antenna terminals.
Remove the vinyl tie and take
out the connection line.
a.With the antenna on top of
any stable surface.
Mount
Connection of AM antennas
1.Push the
lever.
2.Insert the
conductor.
3.Return the
lever.
Bend in the reverse direction.
b.With the antenna attached
to a wall.
NOTE
•Do not connect two FM antennas simultaneously.
•Even if an external AM antenna is used, do not
disconnect the AM loop antenna.
•Make sure the AM loop antenna lead terminals do not
touch metal parts of the panel.
Installation hole Mount on wall, etc.
18
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
22
2007/09/28
11:40:53
ENGLISH
External Controller
Getting Started
Multi-zone
ZONE2 or ZONE3 Pre-out Connections
7*%&0
"6%*0
7*%&0
*/
"6%*0
*/
3
R
L
R
Infrared
retransmitter
Input
Output
Infrared
sensor
Troubleshooting
"69
065
Information
Trigger output jacks
The power of an external device equipped with
a trigger input jack can be turned on and off in
association with operations on the AVR-2808.
For details, see menu “Manual Setup” – “Option
Setup” – “Trigger Out” (vpage 32).
•Output: DC 12 V 150 mA MAX.
Check the trigger input conditions of the
connected device.
Multi-Zone
•When using in combination with an RF Remote Controller (RC-7000CI, sold separately) or RF Remote
Receiver (RC-7001RCI, sold separately) two-way communication with an RF Remote Controller is
possible.
The AVR-2808’s status information as well as iPod can be browsed watching the RF Remote Controller’s
display. For details, refer to the operating instructions of the respective devices.
•When used in combination with an RF Remote Controller or RF Remote Receiver, make the settings at
menu “Manual Setup” – “Option Setup” – “2Way Remote” – “Used” (vpage 32).
Remote Control
L
b If you wish to control the AVR-2808 from
an external controller using the RS-232C
connector, perform the operation below
beforehand.
q Turn on the AVR-2808’s power.
w Turn off the AVR-2808’s power from the
external controller.
e Check that the AVR-2808 is in the standby
mode.
Playback
Power amplifier
(ZONE2 or ZONE3)
This connector is used for an external controller.
Setup
Monitor (ZONE2)
RS-232C connector
Connections
•If another power amplifier or pre-main (integrated) amplifier is connected, the ZONE2 or ZONE3 pre-out
(variable or fixed level) connectors can be used to play a different program source in ZONE2 or ZONE3
the same time (vpage 57 ~ 60).
•When using an S-Video cable or a video cable for connection between the AVR-2808 and an input device,
connect to the video connectors.
•The ZONE2 video out is only for ZONE2.
Extension jack for future use.
NOTE
•For the audio output, use high quality pin-plug cords so that no induction humming or noise is produced.
•For instructions on installing and operating separately sold devices, refer to the respective devices’
operating instructions.
•To conduct multi-zone playback, see “Amp Assign / Multi-zone Connections and Operations” (vpage 57
~ 60).
19
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
23
2007/09/28
11:40:57
ENGLISH
Getting Started
Connecting the Power Cord
Wait until all connections have been completed before connecting the power cord.
Menu Operations
Connection to the AC outlet
Connections
•These outlets supply power to external audio
devices.
•The power supplied from this outlet turns on and off
together with the set’s power switch.
•Audio equipment with a total power consumption
of 100 W (0.43 A) can be connected.
Setup
Playback
Power cord
(included)
With the AVR-2808, settings and operations for most functions can be performed by operating while
looking at the menus displayed on the monitor screen.
uiop
Operations
RETURN
The same operation is possible on the main unit
or remote control unit.
To household
power outlet
(AC 230 V, 50 Hz)
Remote Control
Multi-Zone
Information
1
Press MENU.
2
3
4
Press ui to select the item you want
The menu is displayed.
bTo operate from the main remote control unit,
be sure to set the remote control unit to the
AMP mode.
NOTE
MENU
•Insert the AC plugs securely. Incomplete connections could cause noise.
•Only use the AC outlet to plug in audio devices. Do not use them as power supplies for hairdryers or
anything other than audio equipment.
ENTER
to set, then press ENTER.
Press ui again to select the item you
[
AMP]
want to set, then press ENTER.
To change the setting:
Once Connections are Completed
Turning the Power On (vpage 43)
Press ui to select the item you want
to change, then press o p to change
the setting.
bTo return to the previous item, press RETURN.
Troubleshooting
bSelect “Default Yes”, then press o to reset to
the default setting.
MENU
ENTER
uiop
RETURN
About the button names in these explanations
< > : Buttons on the main unit
[
] : Buttons on the remote control unit
Button name only:
Buttons on the main unit and remote control
unit
5
6
Press ENTER to enter the setting.
Press MENU to finish.
When MENU is pressed, the settings made up to
that point are entered and the settings menu screen
turns off.
20
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
24
2007/09/28
11:40:59
ENGLISH
Some typical examples are described below.
GFront displayH
GOn-screen displayH
Screen title
MENU
*MENU
Auto Setup
[Selectable items]
A
Submenu title
B A+B
Connections
In lists of selectable items or adjustable ranges, the item
surrounded by a border is the default value.
Examples of On-screen Display and Front Display
Getting Started
Example of Display of Default
Values
1.Auto Setup
2.Manual Setup
3.Input Setup
4.Parameter
5.Information
Setup
Press o to execute
Currently selected line
Current setting
Press op to change the setting
3-1.Assign
Digital In
:
OPT1
iPod dock
:
None
Multi-Zone
*Assign
Digital :•OPT1 –
Front Sp. A
Amp Assign
Start
Cancel
Information
2-1-3.Distance
*Distance
Unit:Meter•–Feet
Set The Distance To
Each Speakers
Do You Prefer
In Meters? / In Feet?
Meters
*Rename:DVD
•DV¡
–
Use ui to input characters.
Use op to change the character input
position.
:
Feet
3-3.Rename
DVD
Troubleshooting
Press op to select one or the other
Remote Control
1-1.Start Menu
Audyssey MultEQ XT
Step1:Speaker Detection
Please place microphone
at ear height at
main listening position.
Playback
*Start Menu
Start•
: DV
Default
Yes
3-3.Rename
*Rename:DVD
Rename•– Clear
When highlighted, press i to select
“Default Yes”.
DVD
: DVD-3930
Default
Yes
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
25
2007/09/28
11:41:01
ENGLISH
Getting Started
Menu Map
Auto Setup (vpage 23 ~ 25)
MENU
n Start Menu
• Step 1: Speaker Detection
• Step 2: Measurement
• Step 3: Calculation
• Step 4: Check
• Step 5: Store
Connections
1.Auto Setup
2.Manual Setup
3.Input Setup
4.Parameter
5.Information
n Option
• Room EQ
• Direct Mode Setup
• Mic Select
Setup
n Parameter Check
• Speaker Configuration Check
• Distance Check
• Channel Level Check
• Crossover Frequency Check
• EQ Check
• Restore
Playback
Manual Setup (vpage 26 ~ 33)
Remote Control
Information
(vpage 41, 42)
Multi-Zone
Information
n Status
• Main Zone
• ZONE2/ZONE3
n Audio Input Signal
n HDMI Information
n Auto Surround Mode
n Quick Select
n Preset Station
Troubleshooting
When “Screensaver” is set to
“ON”, the screensaver is activated
if no operation is performed for
about 3 minutes.
When the uiop, ENTER or
MENU button is pressed, the
screensaver is canceled and
the corresponding operation is
performed.
n Speaker Setup (vpage 26, 27)
• Speaker Configuration
• Subwoofer Setup
• Distance
• Channel Level
• Crossover Frequency
n HDMI Setup (vpage 27, 28)
• HDMI Audio Setup
· HDMI Audio Out
· Auto Lipsync
• HDMI Video Setup
· i/p Scaler
· Resolution
· Progressive Mode
· Aspect
· Color Space
· RGB Range
n Audio Setup (vpage 28, 29)
• EXT. IN Subwoofer Level
• 2ch Direct/Stereo
• Dolby Digital Setup
• Auto Surround Mode
• Manual EQ
Parameter
(vpage 38 ~ 41)
n Surround Parameter
• MODE
• CINEMA EQ
• D.COMP
• DRC
• LFE
• CENTER IMAGE
• PANORAMA
• DIMENSION
• CENTER WIDTH
• DELAY TIME
• EFFECT
• LEVEL
• ROOM SIZE
• AFDM
• SB CH OUT
• SW ATT
• Subwoofer
• Default
n Tone Control
• Tone Defeat
• Bass
• Treble
n Room EQ
n RESTORER
n Night Mode
n Audio Delay
n Zone Setup (vpage 30)
• ZONE2 Setup
· Bass
· Treble
· HPF
· Lch Level
· Rch Level
· Channel
· Volume Level
· Volume Limit
· Power On Level
· Mute Level
• ZONE3 Setup
· Bass
· Treble
· HPF
· Lch Level
· Rch Level
· Channel
· Volume Level
· Volume Limit
· Power On Level
· Mute Level
n Option Setup (vpage 31 ~ 33)
• Amp Assign
• Volume Control
· Volume Limit
· Power On Level
· Mute Level
• Source Delete
• On-Screen Display
· Screensaver
· Text
· Master Volume
· Tuner Information
· iPod Information
· Display Mode
• Quick Select Name
• Trigger Out
• Remote ID Setup
• 2Way Remote
• Display
• Setup Lock
Input Setup (vpage 33 ~ 36)
n TUNER (FM/AM)
• Auto Preset
• Preset Skip
• Preset Name
• Input Mode
• Rename
• Other
· Video Select
· Source Level
n PHONO
• Input Mode
• Rename
• Other
· Video Select
· Source Level
n CD, DVD, HDP, TV/CBL,
SAT, VCR, DVR, V.AUX
• Assign
• Input Mode
• Rename
• Other
· Video Select
· Video Convert (Excluding CDs)
· Source Level
• iPod
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
26
2007/09/28
11:41:17
ENGLISH
1
Getting Started
Preparations
Connect the included calibrated setup microphone to
Auto Setup
Sound
receptor
Setup
2
Place the microphone at ear height on a tripod or stand
Playback
with the microphone pointing directly up towards the
ceiling.
Remote Control
Example q
The auto setup screen appears automatically.
Connections
•Audyssey MultEQ® XT automatically measures the acoustical
problems in the listening environment to create the best audio
experience for your home theater.
•It optimizes a large listening area where one or more listeners are
seated.
Measurements are performed by placing the calibrated microphone
(DM-A405) successively at multiple positions throughout the
listening area as shown in Example q. For best results, it is
strongly recommended to measure 6 or more positions so that the
measurements have the proper spatial weighting.
Even if the listening environment is small as shown in Example w,
measuring at multiple points throughout the listening environment
results in more effective correction.
the SETUP MIC jack on the main unit.
Example w
Multi-Zone
Setup
microphone
( :Measuring positions)
*M
The main listening position refers to the most central position where
one would normally sit within the listening environment.
MultEQ XT uses the measurements from this position to calculate
speaker distance, level, polarity, and the optimum crossover value
for the subwoofer.
To make manual adjustments to the settings, see pages 26, 27.
bIt is not recommended to hold it in your hand. Be sure that the
path from microphone to the speakers is not blocked by objects.
Avoid placing the microphone close to a seat back or wall as sound
reflections may give inaccurate results.
Troubleshooting
About the main listening position (*M)
Information
*M
When using a subwoofer, make the following settings before starting
the auto setup procedure:
•Defeat the volume and crossover controls if possible
•If this is not possible then set
• Volume: “12 o’clock” position
• Crossover frequency: “Maximum/Highest Frequency”
• Low pass filter: “Off”
• Standby mode: “Off”
NOTE
•Do not disconnect the setup microphone until the auto setup
procedure is completed.
•When using headphones, unplug the headphones before starting
the auto setup procedure.
23
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
27
2007/09/28
11:41:18
ENGLISH
Getting Started
Auto Setup
Step 1 : Speaker Detection
Optimize settings for speakers in use.
F Menu screen F
Connections
1-1.Start Menu
Audyssey MultEQ XT
Step1:Speaker Detection
Please place microphone
at ear height at
main listening position.
Setup
Front Sp. A
Amp Assign
Start
Cancel
Playback
a Start Menu
The settings are performed automatically.
Remote Control
Start
Multi-Zone
Start Auto Setup.
The Audyssey MultEQ XT Auto Setup process automatically calculates
the size, level, distance, bass management crossover frequency, and
optimal settings for each speaker and subwoofer. Audyssey MultEQ
XT corrects acoustical distortions within the listening area.
Before starting, connect and position all your speakers.
Once started, MultEQ XT will play a series of test tones through each
speaker.
Information
If an error message appears during the measurements, check “Error
Messages”, take the advised action, then start the measurements
again (vpage 25).
Troubleshooting
Front Speaker
The speaker connection and polarity are detected at the fi rst
measurement position. The following attributes are also determined
at this time: “Speaker Size”, “Speaker Distance”, “Channel Level”,
“Crossover Frequency”.
Once the measurements are completed, the results are displayed.
NOTE
• Loud test tone may be played during Audyssey MultEQ XT Automatic
Speaker Setup. This is part of normal operation. If there is background
noise in room, these test tones will increase in volume.
• Do not stand between the speakers and setup microphone or allow
obstacles in the path while the measurements are being made. This
will cause inaccurate readings.
• Quiet the listening environment before beginning measurements and
refrain from talking. Turn off air conditioning units or other devices
that emit noise if at all possible as measurements may be affected
by these sounds.
• Operating the MASTER VOLUME knob on the main unit or the VOL
+/– buttons on the remote control unit during the measurements will
cancel the measurements.
• Do not change the speaker connections or subwoofer volume after
“Step 1”.
Step 2 : Measurement
After completing a measurement position, move the microphone to
the next position.
Step 3 : Calculation
When “Calculate” is selected at “Step 2”, the measurements taken
are analyzed automatically to determine how the speaker system
interacts with the room.
The time required for this analysis depends on the number of speakers
connected. The higher the number of speakers, the longer the time
required for analysis.
Step 4 : Check
Once the auto setup procedure is complete, a measuring result check
screen appears.
Select any item whose results you want to check to review the
results.
Values that are different from the actual distance may be set for
speakers with built-in filters (subwoofers, etc.). This is because filters
add electrical delay to the signal that should be compensated.
Step 5 : Store
The auto setup measurement results are stored in the AVR-2808.
NOTE
Do not turn the power off while the settings are being stored.
Measure at least 6 positions (main listening position and at least 5 other
surrounding positions). For best results it is recommend measuring 6
or more positions (with a maximum of 8 positions).
The front speaker to be measured can be selected ahead of time
here.
[Selectable items]
A
: Output test tone from front speakers A.
B
: Output test tone from front speakers B.
A + B : Output test tone from front speakers A and B.
Amp Assign
Advanced setting : changes power amplifier assignment.
For details, refer to “Amp Assign” (vpage 31).
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
28
2007/09/28
11:41:21
ENGLISH
sOption
If the auto setup procedure could not be completed due to speaker installation, the measuring environment, etc., an error message is
displayed. If this happens, check the relevant items, be sure to take the necessary measures, then perform the auto setup procedure over
again.
Select settings for room EQ, mic, etc.
Measures
[Selectable items]
All
:Apply settings to all surround modes.
Assign :Make settings for each surround mode separately.
Playback
Direct Mode Setup
Retry
Cancel
Select room EQ use for DIRECT or PURE DIRECT mode.
•Too much noise in the room for accurate •Either turn off any device generating noise or move it
measurements to be made.
away.
•Try again when the surroundings are quieter.
•Speaker or subwoofer sound is too low for •Check the speaker installation and the direction in
accurate measurements to be made.
which the speakers are facing.
•Adjust the subwoofer’s volume.
[Selectable items]
ON
:Use room EQ.
OFF
:Do not use room EQ.
Remote Control
Auto Setup
Audyssey MultEQ XT
Caution!
Ambient noise is
too high or
Level is too low.
Select room EQ setting method.
Setup
Auto Setup
Audyssey MultEQ XT
Caution!
Microphone:None
or
Speaker
:None
Cause
•Included setup microphone is not connected. •Connect the included setup microphone to the SETUP
MIC jack on the main unit.
•Check the speaker connections.
•Not all speakers could be detected.
Room EQ
Connections
Error messages (examples)
Getting Started
Error Messages
Mic Select
Retry
Cancel
R :None
Retry
Cancel
Front
L :Phase
Retry
Cancel
Skip
Mic
:Supplied mic is being used.
V.AUX L :Other mic connected to V.AUX is used.
Only a professionally certified installer should ever connect a
professionally-calibrated microphone to the V.AUX L input on the front
panel.
dParameter Check
Troubleshooting
Auto Setup
Audyssey MultEQ XT
Caution!
[Selectable items]
Information
Front
Select the microphone type if not using supplied mic.
The microphone connected to V.AUX Lch is used.
Multi-Zone
Auto Setup
Audyssey MultEQ XT
Caution!
•Displayed speaker could not be detected.
•Check the connections of the displayed speaker.
· The front L and front R speakers were not
properly detected.
· Only one channel of the surround speakers
was detected.
· Sound was output from the R channel
when only one surround back speaker was
connected.
· The surround back speaker was detected,
but the surround speaker was not detected.
•Displayed speaker connected with the •Check the polarities of the displayed speaker.
polarities reversed.
•For some speakers, this error message may be
displayed even if the speaker is properly connected. If
you are sure that the wiring is correct, select “Skip”.
Check auto setup measurement results.
This is displayed after the auto setup procedure is completed.
[Items to be checked]
Select “Retry” to make the measurements again.
NOTE Be sure to turn the power off before checking the speaker connections.
Speaker Config. Check
Distance Check
Channel Level Check
Crossover Freq. Check
EQ Check
The auto setup results can be reset to what was originally calculated
by MultEQ XT when “Restore” is selected.
25
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
29
2007/09/28
11:41:21
ENGLISH
Getting Started
Surround Speaker
sSubwoofer Setup
Select surround speakers use and size.
[Selectable items] Large
Manual Setup
Small
Select low range signal to be reproduced by subwoofer.
None
Connections
LFE
Surround Back Speaker
Make detail settings for various parameters.
Select surround back speaker use and size.
[Selectable items] Large
Speaker Setup
Setup
Use this procedure to set the speakers manually or if you wish to
change the settings made with the auto setup procedure.
Playback
F Menu screen F
2spkrs
Small
None
frequency reproduction capabilities.
2.Manual Setup
Remote Control
1.Auto Setup
2.Manual Setup
3.Input Setup
4.Parameter
5.Information
1.Speaker Setup
2.HDMI Setup
3.Audio Setup
4.Zone Setup
5.Option Setup
Multi-Zone
aSpeaker Configuration
Information
Select speaker configuration and size.
(bass reproduction capability)
Troubleshooting
Select front speaker size.
Small
Center Speaker
Select center speaker use and size.
[Selectable items] Large
Small
Subwoofer
LFE+Main :Play low range and LFE signal of all channels.
Small :Select this when using small speakers without ample low
frequency reproduction capabilities.
•This can be set when menu “Speaker Configuration” – “Subwoofer”
is set to “Yes”.
•Play music or a movie source and select the mode offering the
strongest bass.
•Select “LFE+Main” if you want the bass signals to always be
produced from the subwoofer.
None :Select this when no speaker is connected.
Yes
:Select this when a subwoofer is connected.
No
:Select this when no subwoofer is connected.
2spkrs
1spkr :
Select the number of surround back speakers.
dDistance
Set distance from listening position to speakers.
Before making the settings, measure the distance from the
listening position to the different speakers.
Meters / Feet
Select unit for distance.
Front Speaker
[Selectable items] Large
:Play low range and LFE signal of channels set to
“Small”.
1spkr
Large :Select this when using large speakers with ample low
MENU
[Selectable items]
None
•Select “Large” or “Small” not according to the physical size of the
speaker but according to the low frequency reproduction capabilities
based on the frequency set at “Crossover Frequency” (vpage
27).
•When “Front Speaker” is set to “Small”,“Subwoofer” is automatically
set to “Yes”.
•If “Subwoofer” is set to “No”, “Front Speaker” is automatically set to
“Large”.
•If “Surround Speaker” is set to “None”, “Surround Back Speaker” are
automatically set to “None”.
•When using just one surround back speaker, connect it to the left
channel (SBL).
Step
Select step. (smallest distance)
[Selectable items]
0.1m
1ft
0.01m :Can be selected when “Meters” is set.
0.1ft :Can be selected when “Feet” is set.
Default
Resets the settings to the default values.
Select subwoofer use.
[Selectable items]
Yes
No
26
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
30
2007/09/28
11:41:22
ENGLISH
Distance measurement
[Variable range]
0.0ft ~ 60.0ft
:Display when “Feet” is set.
NOTE
Select test tone playback method.
Auto
:Automatically switch speaker from which test tone is
output.
Manual :Manually switch speaker from which test tone is output.
[Selectable items]
40Hz
60Hz
200Hz
250Hz :
80Hz
90Hz
100Hz
110Hz
120Hz
150Hz
Only the portion of the bass sound of the various speakers output
from the subwoofer that has a frequency below the frequency set
here is output.
Set this according to the low frequency reproduction capabilities of the
speakers you are using.
HDMI Audio Out
Select HDMI audio output device.
[Selectable items]
AMP :Use speakers connected to receiver for audio playback.
TV
:Use speakers of monitor for audio playback.
Advanced :
~ +12dB
Default
Resets the settings to the default values.
Operating from the main remote control unit
Adjusting with the main remote control unit using the test tones is
only possible in the “Auto” mode and only effective in the STANDARD
(Dolby/DTS Surround) mode. The adjusted levels for the different
modes are automatically stored in the memory.
•The “Crossover Frequency” can be set when there are speakers that
have been set to “Small” at menu “Speaker Configuration” or when
“Subwoofer” is set to “Yes” (vpage 26).
•At the “Advanced” settings, if the menu “Subwoofer Setup” setting
is set to “LFE”, speakers for which “Speaker Configuration” is set to
“Small” can be set. If set to “LFE+Main”, the setting can be made
regardless of the speaker size.
•For speakers set to “Small”, sound below the crossover frequency
is cut from the sound output. The cut bass sound is output from the
subwoofer or front speakers.
•Always set the crossover frequency to “80 Hz”. When using small
speakers, however, we recommend setting the crossover frequency
to a higher frequency.
[Selectable items]
ON
:Use automatic compensation.
OFF
:Do not use automatic compensation.
Troubleshooting
0dB
Information
Auto Lipsync
Automatic compensation for timing shift in audio and video output.
Output test tone.
[Variable range] –12dB ~
aHDMI Audio Setup
Make settings for HDMI audio output.
Set the crossover frequency separately for the different speakers.
Test Tone Start
1.HDMI Audio Setup
2.HDMI Video Setup
Multi-Zone
[Selectable items]
2-2.HDMI Setup
Remote Control
Test Tone
1.Speaker Setup
2.HDMI Setup
3.Audio Setup
4.Zone Setup
5.Option Setup
Playback
Adjust channel levels to obtain equal volume from all speakers.
2.Manual Setup
gCrossover Frequency
Select crossover frequency from which subwoofer handles low
range signal.
fChannel Level
F Menu screen F
Setup
Set the distance between the listening position and the various
speakers to no more than 6.00 meters (20.0 ft).
Make settings for HDMI video/audio output.
Connections
0.00m ~ 18.00m :Display when “Meters” is set.
HDMI Setup
•When the menu “Speaker Configuration” – “Surround Back Speaker”
setting (vpage 26) is set to “1spkr”, the surround back speaker
display is set to “Surround Back Speaker”.
•Speakers set to “None” in the “Speaker Configuration” settings are
not displayed.
•When “Channel Level” is adjusted, the adjusted values are set for
all the surround modes. To adjust the channel level separately for the
different surround modes, use the operation see page 49.
Getting Started
Select the speaker you want to set, then set the distance.
Set the value closest to the measured distance.
GAdjusting using test tonesH
q Press the TEST button.
Test tones are output from the various speakers.
w Use the o p button to adjust so that the volume is equal for all
speakers.
e When the adjustments are completed, press the TEST button
again.
27
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
31
2007/09/28
11:41:23
ENGLISH
Getting Started
sHDMI Video Setup
Make settings for HDMI video output.
i/p Scaler
Connections
Make settings for i/p scaler function.
[Selectable items]
Aspect
This sets the aspect ratio when outputting 480i/576i or 480p/576p
input signals from the HDMI output connector.
[Selectable items]
FULL
:Output at 16:9 aspect ratio.
NORMAL :Output at 4:3 aspect ratio.
A to H :Use i/p scaler function for analog video signal.
Setup
OFF
:Do not use i/p scaler function.
Playback
Resolution
Make settings for resolution of HDMI video output signal.
[Selectable items]
Remote Control
Auto
:Detect monitor panel resolution and automatically set
output resolution.
Multi-Zone
:Output at 1080i resolution.
720p
:Output at 720p resolution.
1080p
:Output at 1080p resolution.
Make settings for audio playback.
F Menu screen F
2.Manual Setup
1.Speaker Setup
2.HDMI Setup
3.Audio Setup
4.Zone Setup
5.Option Setup
2-3.Audio Setup
1.EXT.IN SW Level
2.2ch Direct/Stereo
3.Dolby Digital Setup
4.Auto Surround Mode
5.Manual EQ
This can be set when “i/p Scaler” is set to “A to H”.
Color Space
Make settings for output color space.
[Selectable items]
YCbCr
RGB
:Output using YCbCr format.
:Output using RGB format.
aEXT. IN Subwoofer Level
Set the subwoofer level for playback.
[Selectable items]
0dB
480p/576p :Output at 480p/576p resolution.
1080i
Audio Setup
+5dB
+10dB :
Select according to the player in use.
When connected to a monitor with a DVI-D connector (HDCP
compatible) using an HDMI/DVI converter cable, the signals are output
in RGB format, regardless of this setting.
+15dB :
This is the recommended level.
RGB Range
Information
This can be set when “i/p Scaler” is set to “A to H”.
NOTE
Troubleshooting
•It is not possible to convert “1080i” signals into “720p” format.
•It is not possible to convert “720p” signals into “1080i” format.
Progressive Mode
Make settings for RGB output range.
s2ch Direct/Stereo
[Selectable items]
Make speaker settings for 2-channel mode playback.
Normal
:Use video range from 16 (black) to 235 (white).
Enhanced :Video range from 0 (black) to 255 (white). Use this setting
to avoid black washout.
Auto
:Automatically detect video material type.
Video1
:Select mode suitable for video playback.
Video2
:Select mode suitable for video and 30-frame film material
playback.
To change the settings, select “Custom”.
[Selectable items]
Select optimum progressive mode for video material.
[Selectable items]
Setting
When “YCbCr” is selected under “Color Space”, “RGB Range” will
have no effect.
Basic :Use the same settings as in “Speaker Setup”.
Custom :Make separate settings for 2-channel mode.
This can be set when “i/p Scaler” is set to “A to H”.
28
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
32
2007/09/28
11:41:24
ENGLISH
Select front speaker size.
[Selectable items]
Large
dDolby Digital Setup
gManual EQ
Set dynamic range for downmix playback of Dolby Digital
sources.
Adjust tonal quality for each speaker using graphic equalizer.
[Selectable items]
Small :Select front speaker size.
Select subwoofer use.
ON
:Compression is used. Select this if sound from front
speakers is distorted.
OFF
:Do not use compression. This is the recommended setting.
Base Curve Copy
Copy the Room EQ’s “Audyssey Flat” correction curve.
[Selectable items]
Yes
Connections
Subwoofer
Getting Started
Front
No
Yes
No
:Select subwoofer use.
Subwoofer Mode
Select low range signal to be reproduced by subwoofer.
[Selectable items]
Select speaker adjustment method.
[Selectable items]
LFE+Main :Select subwoofer signal.
fAuto Surround Mode
Make setting for memorizing surround mode setting for each input
signal type.
Crossover
[Selectable items]
ON
[Selectable items]
60Hz
90Hz
100Hz
110Hz
200Hz
250Hz :Select crossover frequency.
120Hz
Distance FL
[Variable range] 0.00m ~ 18.00m
Distance FR
Set distance from listening position to front right speaker.
[Variable range] 0.00m ~ 18.00m
OFF
:Do not memorize settings. Surround mode does not change
according to input signal.
•The auto surround mode function lets you store in the memory the
surround mode last used for playing the four types of input signals
listed below.
qAnalog and PCM 2-channel signals
wDolby Digital and DTS 2-channel signals
eDolby Digital and DTS multi-channel signals
rMulti-channel signals other than Dolby Digital and DTS (PCM,
DSD, etc.)
•When playing in the PURE DIRECT mode, the surround mode does
not change even if the input signal is changed.
ALL CH :Adjust tonal quality for all speakers together.
Manual EQ
Select the speaker and frequency band and adjust the level.
[Selectable items] 63Hz 125Hz
[Variable range]
2kHz
4kHz
20dB
~
250Hz
8kHz
0dB
~
500Hz
1kHz
16kHz
+6dB
Troubleshooting
Set distance from listening position to front left speaker.
150Hz
L/R CH :Adjust tonal quality for each L/R speaker pair.
Information
40Hz
:Memorize settings. Most recently stored surround mode is
automatically selected.
Each CH :Adjust tonal quality for each speaker separately.
Multi-Zone
Select crossover frequency from which subwoofer handles low range
signal.
80Hz
Adjust CH
Remote Control
LFE
“Base Curve Copy” is displayed after the auto setup procedure has
been performed.
Playback
•Set this to “ON” if the sound from the front speakers seems
distorted.
•When not using the center speaker or surround speakers, the
playback sound is down-mixed and output from the front speakers.
Setup
[Selectable items]
Default
Resets the settings to the default values.
29
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
33
2007/09/28
11:41:24
ENGLISH
Getting Started
Zone Setup
Lch Level
Volume Limit
Make settings for audio playback in a multi-zone system.
Adjust the left channel output level.
Make a setting for maximum volume.
F Menu screen F
[Variable range] –12dB ~
0dB
~ +12dB
2.Manual Setup
2-4.Zone Setup
Connections
1.Speaker Setup
2.HDMI Setup
3.Audio Setup
4.Zone Setup
5.Option Setup
1.ZONE2 Setup
2.ZONE3 Setup
OFF
Rch Level
0dB
~ +12dB
Setup
Channel
Switch between stereo and mono output.
Playback
[Selectable items]
aZONE2 Setup
Make settings for audio playback in a ZONE2 system.
Remote Control
sZONE3 Setup
Stereo :Select stereo output.
Multi-Zone
Adjust low frequency range (bass).
Information
Treble
[Variable range] –10dB ~
0dB
When menu “Manual Setup” – “Option Setup” – “Amp Assign”
(vpage 31) is set to ZONE2/3-MONO”, the “Channel” setting is
automatically set to “Mono”.
~ +10dB
[Variable range] –10dB ~
0dB
Troubleshooting
When using speakers that cannot satisfactorily play low frequencies,
distortion of the bass sound can be reduced by setting “HPF” to
“ON”.
[Selectable items]
OFF
:The low range is not attenuated.
ON
:The low range is attenuated.
Power On Level
Define the volume setting that is active when the power is turned on.
[Selectable items]
Last
:Use the memorized setting from the last session.
–––
:Always use the muting on condition when power
is turned on.
–70dB ~ +18dB :Set the volume level when the power is turned on
in units of 1 dB.
Mute Level
Adjust the main volume level.
[Selectable items]
:Allow volume adjustment by remote control.
–40dB :Fix the volume to –40 dB.
0dB
HPF
:Set the maximum volume to 0 dB.
Set the amount of attenuation when muting is on.
VAR
~ +10dB
0dB
Volume Level
[Selectable items]
Adjust high frequency range (treble).
–10dB :Set the maximum volume to –10 dB.
Mono :Select monaural output.
Make settings for audio playback in a ZONE3 system.
Bass
:Do not set a maximum volume.
–20dB :Set the maximum volume to –20 dB.
Adjust the right channel output level.
[Variable range] –12dB ~
[Selectable items]
Full
:The sound is cut off entirely.
–40dB :The sound is attenuated by 40 dB.
–20dB :The sound is attenuated by 20 dB.
:Fix the volume to 0 dB.
“VAR” is displayed when a power amplifier is assigned to the ZONE2
output channel at menu “Manual Setup” – “Option Setup” – “Amp
Assign” (vpage 31).
30
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
34
2007/09/28
11:41:25
ENGLISH
sVolume Control
dSource Delete
Make various other settings.
Set the main zone volume setting.
Remove input sources that are not used from the display.
F Menu screen F
Make a setting for maximum volume.
[Selectable items]
OFF
:Do not set a maximum volume.
–20dB :Set the maximum volume to –20 dB.
–10dB :Set the maximum volume to –10 dB.
aAmp Assign
FrontB Bi-Amp
Last
:Use the memorized setting from the last session.
–––
:Always use the muting on condition when power
is turned on.
in units of 1 dB.
ZONE3
ZONE2/3-MONO
FrontA Bi-Amp
2ch
Mute Level
This sets the amount of attenuation of the volume when the mute
mode is set in the main zone.
[Selectable items]
Full
:The sound is cut off entirely.
Screensaver
Make screensaver settings.
Use the screensaver to prevent burn-in on the monitor screen.
When set to “ON”, the screensaver is activated if there is no activity
for about 3 minutes.
[Selectable items]
ON
:Activate the screensaver if there is no activity for about 3
minutes.
OFF
:Turn the screensaver function off.
Troubleshooting
For details, see “Amp Assign / Multi-zone Connections and Operations”
(vpage 57 ~ 59).
Make on-screen display related settings.
Text
–40dB :The sound is attenuated by 40 dB.
Input source and mode display.
–20dB :The sound is attenuated by 20 dB.
[Selectable items]
ON
:Turn display on.
OFF
:Turn display off.
Information
ZONE2
fOn-Screen Display
[Selectable items]
–80dB ~ +18dB :Set the volume level when the power is turned on
[Selectable items]
7.1ch
This sets the volume set when the main zone’s power is turned on.
NOTE
•Input sources being used in the various zones cannot be deleted.
•Input sources set to “Delete” cannot be selected using the SOURCE
SELECT knob on the main unit or SOURCE SELECT button on the remote
control unit.
Multi-Zone
The places where the surround back amplifier are used can be set
freely according to the usage environment. This makes it possible to
output sound to rooms other than the room (the main zone) where
surround playback is performed (multi-zone playback) or play the sound
with high quality using the front speakers (bi-amp connections).
Power On Level
Delete :Do not use this source.
Remote Control
Define how the amplifier for the surround back speaker channels
is used.
:Set the maximum volume to 0 dB.
:Use this source.
Playback
0dB
ON
Setup
2-5.Option Setup
1.Amp Assign
2.Vol.Control
3.Source Delete
4.On-Screen Display
5.Quick Select Name
6.Trigger Out
7.Remote ID Setup
8.2Way Remote
9.Display
10.Setup Lock
Connections
1.Speaker Setup
2.HDMI Setup
3.Audio Setup
4.Zone Setup
5.Option Setup
[Selectable items]
Volume Limit
2.Manual Setup
Getting Started
Option Setup
Master Volume
Master volume display during adjustment.
[Selectable items]
ON
:Turn display on.
OFF
:Turn display off.
31
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
35
2007/09/28
11:41:26
ENGLISH
Getting Started
Tuner Information
This sets the time the on-screen display is displayed when an operation
is performed.
[Selectable items]
Connections
Always :Show display continuously.
hTrigger Out
jRemote ID Setup
Select the conditions to turn on the trigger out with respect to the
zone, input source, surround mode. For details about the trigger
out function, see page 19.
Set remote control ID.
Match the ID setting of the remote control unit and the receiver.
Select “Trigger Out 1” or “Trigger Out 2” and make the settings below
respectively.
Setup
30sec
:Show display for 30 seconds after operation.
10sec
:Show display for 10 seconds after operation.
Selecting the Zone
:Turn display off.
Select the zone for which the trigger out is set.
OFF
iPod Information
Playback
This sets the time the on-screen display is displayed when an operation
is performed.
Remote Control
[Selectable items]
Always :Show display continuously.
30sec
:Show display for 30 seconds after operation.
10sec
:Show display for 10 seconds after operation.
Multi-Zone
OFF
:Turn display off.
Display Mode
Select the on-screen display's display mode.
Information
[Selectable items]
Mode1 :If there is no video signal, flickering of the on-screen display
is not prevented.
Troubleshooting
Mode2 :Prevents flickering of the on-screen display when there is
no video signal.
Use this mode if the on-screen display does not appear
in the Mode 1, as may happen according to the TV being
used.
gQuick Select Name
Change the Quick Select name.
Up to 16 characters can be input.
[Input characters]
A ~ Z a ~ z 0 ~ 9 ! # % & ’ ( ) * + , - . / : ; = “ ? @ [ \ ] (space)
Setting with Respect to the Input Source
[Selectable items]
1
2
3
4
:
Match the ID setting of the remote control and the receiver.
When changing the remote ID, also change the AMP, iPod and TU
modes of the main remote control unit at the same time (vpage
54).
When the input source set to on is selected, the trigger out turns on.
Setting with Respect to the Surround Mode
•When the surround mode set to on is selected, the trigger out turns
on.
•Associated with respect to surround modes that are set to “ON”.
•This can be set if the “MAIN ZONE” is selected at “Selecting the
Zone”.
•Associated when an input source for which “Setting with Respect to
the Input Source” is set to “ON” is selected.
[Selectable items]
ON
–––
k2Way Remote
Make setting for 2-way remote control unit.
[Selectable items]
Used
:Use 2-way remote control.
Not Used :Do not use 2-way remote control.
When using a 2-way remote control unit (RC-7000CI and RC-7001RCI,
sold separately), set this to “Used”.
:Activate trigger on this mode.
:Do not activate trigger on this mode.
lDisplay
Adjust display brightness of the receiver.
[Selectable items]
Bright :Normal display brightness.
Dim
:Reduced display brightness.
Dark
:Very low display brightness.
OFF
:Display is off unless controls are operated.
Operating from the main unit
Press the DIMMER button.
Bright
OFF
Dim
Dark
32
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
36
2007/09/28
11:41:27
ENGLISH
Protect settings from inadvertent change.
“V.AUX”.
Input Setup
[Selectable items]
OFF
:Turn protection off.
F Menu screen F
3.Input Setup
CD
Use this procedure to select the input source and make the settings
related to playing input sources.
nTUNER (AM/FM)
This menu is for “TUNER”.
1.Assign
2.Input Mode
3.Rename
4.Other
Setup
F Menu screen F
3.Input Setup
TUNER
1.Auto Preset
2.Preset Skip
3.Preset Name
4.Input Mode
5.Rename
6.Other
bThe menu settings below can be made for these input sources
when “iPod dock” is set to “Assign”.
3.Input Setup
VCR
3-5.iPod
Repeat
:
OFF
Shuffle
:
OFF
Remote Control
1.Assign
2.Input Mode
3.Rename
4.Other
5.iPod
Multi-Zone
nPHONO
This menu is for “PHONO”.
F Menu screen F
PHONO
1.Input Mode
2.Rename
3.Other
Changing the input source within Input Setup
Information
3.Input Setup
Playback
•When “Setup Lock” is set to “ON”, the settings listed below can
no longer be changed. Also, “SETUP LOCKED!” is displayed if you
attempt to operate related buttons.
⋅ Menu operations
⋅ RESTORER
⋅ Night Mode
⋅ Parameter
⋅ Room EQ
⋅ Channel Level
⋅ Audio Delay
•To cancel the setting, press the MENU button to re-display the “Setup
Lock” screen, then change the setting to “OFF”.
Connections
ON
:Turn protection on.
Getting Started
nCD, DVD, HDP, TV/CBL, SAT, VCR, DVR, V.AUX
This menu is for “CD”, “DVD”, “HDP”, “TV/CBL”, “SAT”, “VCR”, “DVR”,
A0Setup Lock
3.Input Setup
CD
Troubleshooting
1.Assign
2.Input Mode
3.Rename
4.Other
The input source currently selected in the main zone is not changed
even when the input source within Input Setup is changed.
33
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
37
2007/09/28
11:41:27
ENGLISH
Getting Started
Settings Related to Playing Input
Sources
Connections
Auto Preset
Use the auto preset function to program radio stations.
[Input source] TUNER
Setup
[Selectable items]
Start :Start the auto preset process.
Input Mode
Make input mode and decode mode settings for this source.
The selectable input modes depend on the input source and
“Assign” setting (vpage 35).
Press the INPUT MODE button on the main unit or the INPUT button on
the main remote control unit.
AUTO
Input Mode
[Input source] TUNER
[Selectable items]
Analog :Play only signals from analog input.
Playback
Remote Control
TV/CBL
Set the preset memories that you do not want to display when
tuning.
SAT
VCR
DVR
AUTO :Automatically detect input signal and perform playback.
Multi-Zone
HDMI :Play only signals from HDMI input. Excluding CD.
Information
Digital :Play only signals from digital input.
Select the preset channel(s) you do not want to display.
Analog :Play only signals from analog input.
[Input source] TUNER
EXT. IN :Play only signals from EXT. IN input.
[Selectable items]
Troubleshooting
ON
:Display this number.
Skip :Skip this number.
Preset Name
Assign name to a preset memory.
Names containing up to 8 characters can be input.
Analog
Set the decode mode for this source.
[Selectable items]
A~G
Digital
Decode Mode
[Input source] CD DVD HDP
•When a digital signal is properly input, the “
” indicator lights on
the display. If the “
” indicator does not light, check the digital
input connector assignment and the connections.
•The surround mode cannot be set if the input mode is set to “EXT.
IN”.
TV/CBL
SAT
VCR
DVR
V.AUX
V.AUX
Preset Skip
z2
z1
z1:This can be selected for input sources for which the menu
“Assign” setting is set to “HDMI” (vpage 35). Excluding CD.
z2: This can be selected for input sources for which the menu
“Assign” setting is set to “Digital In” (vpage 35).
PHONO
[Input source] CD DVD HDP
HDMI
EXT. IN
Set the input mode for this source.
EXT. IN :Play only signals from EXT. IN input.
If an FM station cannot be preset automatically, select the desired
station by tuning it in manually, then preset it manually.
Operating from the main unit or main remote
control unit
[Selectable items]
AUTO :Detect type of digital input signal and decode and play
automatically.
PCM :Decode and play only PCM input signals.
DTS :Decode and play only DTS input signals.
•This can be selected for input sources for which the menu “Assign”
setting is set to “HDMI” or “Digital In” (vpage 35).
•Only set “PCM” and “DTS” when playing the respective signals.
Rename
Change the display name for this source.
Names containing up to 8 characters can be input.
[Characters that can be input]
A~Z a~z 0~9
! # % & ’ ( ) * + , - . / : ; = “ ? @ [ \ ] (space)
A1 ~ G8
Select the preset memory number.
[Input source] TUNER
[Characters that can be input]
A~Z a~z 0~9
! # % & ’ ( ) * + , - . / : ; = “ ? @ [ \ ] (space)
34
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
38
2007/09/28
11:41:28
ENGLISH
Assign input sources to input connectors.
Digital In
iPod dock
Select digital input connector to assign to this source.
Assign Control Dock for iPod to this source.
[Input source] CD DVD HDP
HDMI
TV/CBL
SAT
DVR
[Input source] CD DVD HDP
V.AUX
[Input source] DVD HDP
TV/CBL
SAT
DVR
:Assign COAXIAL 1 input connector.
COAX2
:Assign COAXIAL 2 input connector.
COAX3
:Assign COAXIAL 3 input connector.
HDMI1 :Assign HDMI1 input connector.
OPT1
:Assign OPTICAL 1 input connector.
HDMI2 :Assign HDMI2 input connector.
OPT2
:Assign OPTICAL 2 input connector.
OPT3
:Assign OPTICAL 3 input connector.
OPT4
:Assign OPTICAL 4 input connector.
None
:No digital input connector assigned.
HDMI1
HDP
HDMI2
TV/CBL
None
SAT
None
VCR
None
DVR
None
V.AUX
None
CD
DVD
COAX
3
COAX
1
With the default settings, the Control Dock for iPod can be used
connected to the VCR (iPod) connector.
iPod
Make settings for “iPod” playback.
HDP
TV/CBL
SAT
VCR
DVR
V.AUX
None
COAX
2
OPT
1
OPT
3
OPT
2
OPT
4
[Input source] CD DVD HDP
TV/CBL
SAT
VCR
DVR
V.AUX
Multi-Zone
Repeat
Component In
Make settings for repeat mode.
Select component video input to assign to this source.
[Input source] DVD HDP
TV/CBL
SAT
VCR
Information
•With HDMI, the video and audio signals are transferred simultaneously.
To play the video signal assigned at “HDMI” combined with the
audio signal assigned at “Digital”, select “Digital” at menu “Input
Setup” – “Input Mode” (vpage 34).
•When the AVR-2808 and monitor are connected with an HDMI cable,
if the monitor is not compatible with HDMI audio signal playback,
only the video signals are output to the monitor.
•The audio signals input from the analog, digital and EXT. IN connectors
are not output to the monitor.
Input
source
Default
setting
None :Do not assign iPod input.
[Selectable items]
DVR
V.AUX
:Repeat all songs.
One
:Repeat the current song.
OFF
:Cancel repeat mode.
Troubleshooting
[Selectable items]
All
Remote Control
DVD
Assign :Assign iPod input.
Playback
None :No HDMI input connector assigned.
DVR
Setup
[Selectable items]
VCR
[Selectable items]
COAX1
V.AUX
SAT
V.AUX
[Selectable items]
VCR
TV/CBL
Connections
Select HDMI connector to assign to this source.
Input
source
Default
setting
VCR
Getting Started
Assign
1-RCA :Assign component video 1 input connector.
2-RCA :Assign component video 2 input connector.
3-RCA :Assign component video 3 input connector.
None :No component video input connector assigned.
Input
source
Default
setting
DVD
HDP
TV/CBL
SAT
VCR
DVR
V.AUX
1-RCA
2-RCA
3-RCA
None
None
None
None
35
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
39
2007/09/28
11:41:29
ENGLISH
Getting Started
Shuffle
Video Convert
Make settings for shuffle mode.
Automatically convert video input signal to monitor output format.
[Selectable items]
[Input source] DVD HDP
Songs :Shuffle all songs.
SAT
VCR
DVR
V.AUX
Connections
Albums :Shuffle songs from current album only.
OFF
TV/CBL
[Selectable items]
:Cancel shuffle mode.
Setup
This can be selected for input sources for which “Assign” is assigned
at the “iPod dock” setting.
ON
:Enable conversion.
OFF
:Disable conversion.
Standard Playback
This is the standard mode for enjoying surround sound according
to the program source.
NOTE
Playback
When a non-standard video signal from a game machine or some other
source is input, the video conversion function might not operate. If this
happens, please set the conversion mode to “OFF”.
Other
Remote Control
Corrects the playback level of the selected input source’s audio input.
Video Select
[Variable range] –12dB ~
0dB
~ +12dB
Switch video input source while listening to audio signal.
Multi-Zone
HDP
TV/CBL
SAT
VCR
DVR
V.AUX :
Select video input source to view.
Information
Source :
The video and audio for the same input source are played.
Operating from the main unit
Troubleshooting
Press the VIDEO SELECT button, then turn the SOURCE SELECT knob until
the desired picture appears.
b To cancel, press the main unit’s VIDEO SELECT button, then turn the
main unit’s SOURCE SELECT knob and select “Source”.
nWhen using a surround back speaker
[Selectable items] DOLBY PLgx DTS NEO:6
nWhen not using a surround back speaker
[Selectable items]
DVD
To select these surround modes pressing the STANDARD button on the
main unit or press the STD button on the main remote control unit. The
mode switches each time the button is pressed.
Surround Playback of 2-channel Sources
Source Level
Make various other settings.
Surround Modes
For input sources for which “HDMI” and “Digital” are set at the menu
“Assign” setting, the analog input level and digital input level can be
set separately.
[Selectable items] DOLBY PLg
DOLBY PLgx
or DOLBY PLg
:The signals are decoded in DOLBY PLgx or
DOLBY PLg for playback.
Cinema
:This mode is suited for movie sources.
Music
:This mode is suited for music sources.
Game
:This mode is suited for games.
Pro Logic :This is the Pro Logic playback mode. This can
be selected when playing with a DOLBY PLg
decoder. When this mode is selected, “DOLBY
PL” is displayed.
NOTE
•It is not possible to select HDMI input signals.
•When playing HDMI video input signals, the analog video signal of
another input source cannot be selected for the HDMI video output.
•Input sources for which “Delete” is selected at “Source Delete”
cannot be selected.
DTS NEO:6
DTS NEO:6
:The signals are decoded in DTS NEO:6 for
playback.
Cinema
:This mode is suited for movie sources.
Music
:This mode is suited for music sources.
Select the “Cinema”,“Music”,“Game” and “Pro Logic” modes at menu
“Parameter” – “Surround Parameter” – “MODE” (vpage 38).
36
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
40
2007/09/28
11:41:30
ENGLISH
[Selectable items]
Dolby
Digital
Source
DTS-HD HI RES
DTS-HD MSTR
MULTI CH IN
MULTI IN+PLgx CINEMA
MULTI IN+PLgx MUSIC
MULTI CH IN 7.1
For details, see page 66.
mode, the sound will be off balance with a single channel (left or
right), so input to both channels.
•Press the DSP SIMULATION button on the main unit or SIMU button on
the main remote control unit to switch the surround mode.
•Depending on the program source being played, it may not be
possible to achieve a satisfactory surround effect. In this case, try
other modes to achieve a sound field suited to your tastes.
[Selectable items]
DIRECT :
In this mode the signals bypass the tone control circuitry for high
quality sound.
The sound is output to the same channels as the input signal.
The display when the DIRECT mode is selected depends on the input
signal.
For multi-channel sources, the display depends on the surround back
output’s play mode.
Display
Input signal
Analog signal /
PCM (2ch) /
Dolby Digital source /
DTS source /
Other 2-channel digital signals
DSD (2ch)
PCM (multi ch)
DSD (multi ch)
DIRECT
DSD DIRECT (z)
MULTI CH DIRECT
M DIRECT + PLgx CINEMA
M DIRECT + PLgx MUSIC
M DIRECT 7.1
DSD MULTI DIRECT (z)
Troubleshooting
z1 : This is displayed when the input signal is “DTS-ES Matrix 6.1”
and the AVR-2808’s “AFDM” setting is set to “ON”.
z2 : This is displayed when the input signal is “DTS-ES Discrete
6.1”.
z3 : This is displayed when the input signal is “DTS 96/24”.
z:When playing sources recorded in monaural in the MONO MOVIE
Direct Playback
Information
PCM (multi ch) /
DSD (multi ch)
DOLBY TrueHD
DTS SURROUND
DTS+PLgx CINEMA
DTS+PLgx MUSIC
DTS+NEO:6
DTS ES MTRX6.1 (z1)
DTS ES DSCRT6.1 (z2)
DTS 96/24 (z3)
The mode switches between DIRECT and STEREO each time the
DIRECT/STEREO button on the main unit or the D/ST button on the main
remote control unit is pressed.
Multi-Zone
DVDAudio,
SACD
DOLBY DIGITAL +
:This mode is for enjoying stereo sound from
all speakers.
:This mode is for enjoying the atmosphere of
WIDE SCREEN
viewing a movie on a large screen.
SUPER STADIUM :This mode is suited for viewing sports
programs.
:This mode is for enjoying the atmosphere of a
ROCK ARENA
live concert in an arena.
:This mode is for enjoying the atmosphere of a
JAZZ CLUB
live concert in a jazz club.
CLASSIC CONCERT :This mode is for appreciating classical concert
programs.
z
:This mode is for playing monaural movie
MONO MOVIE
sources with surround sound.
:This mode is suited for achieving surround
VIDEO GAME
sound with video games.
:This mode lets you add a sense of expansion
MATRIX
to stereo music sources.
:This mode is for enjoying surround effects
VIRTUAL
using only the front speakers or headphones.
Remote Control
DTS
Surround
Source
Display
DOLBY DIGITAL
DOLBY DIGITAL EX
DOLBY DIGITAL+PLgx CINEMA
DOLBY DIGITAL+PLgx MUSIC
7CH STEREO
STEREO :
This is the mode for playing in stereo. The tone can be adjusted.
Sound is output from the front left and right speakers and subwoofer.
Playback
DOLBY DIGITAL
(other than 2ch) /
DOLBY DIGITAL
EX
DOLBY DIGITAL
Plus
DOLBY TrueHD
DTS (5.1ch) /
DTS-ES Discrete
6.1 /
DTS-ES Matrix
6.1 /
DTS 96/24
DTS-HD High
Resolution Audio
DTS-HD Master
Audio
[Selectable items]
[Selectable items]
Setup
Input signal
The desired mode according to the program source and viewing
situation can be selected from among 10 DENON original surround
modes.
The surround parameters can be adjusted (vpage 64, 65) to
achieve an even more realistic, powerful sound field.
Stereo Playback
Connections
STANDARD :
his mode is for decoding the input signals according to their format
T
and playing surround sound.
The display when the STANDARD mode is selected depends on the
input signal and surround back output playback mode.
DSP Simulation Playback
Getting Started
Playing Multi-channel Sources
(Dolby Digital, DTS, etc.)
z :When DSD signals are converted to PCM signals as set by the
audio parameters and speaker settings, “DIRECT” or “MULTI CH
DIRECT” is displayed.
For details, see page 67.
37
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
41
2007/09/28
11:41:31
ENGLISH
Getting Started
Playback in the PURE DIRECT Mode
This is the mode that recreates the original sound most faithfully,
providing extremely high quality sound.
Connections
Press the PURE DIRECT button on the main unit or the
PURE button on the main remote control unit.
Setup
Playback
•When in the PURE DIRECT mode, the menu screen is not displayed
and the display on the main unit is turned off.
•If the HDMI input connector is selected, video outputs are output in
the PURE DIRECT mode.
•The channel level and surround parameters in the PURE DIRECT
mode are the same as in the DIRECT mode.
The MUSIC mode is also effective for movie sources including a lot of
stereo music.
Parameter
CINEMA EQ
Parameters can be called out directly by pressing the PARA button on
the main remote control unit.
Soften the treble
understanding.
range
of
movie
soundtracks
for
better
[Selectable items]
F Menu screen F
4.Parameter
1.Surround Parameter
2.Tone Control
3.Room EQ
4.RESTORER
5.Night Mode
6.Audio Delay
ON
:CINEMA EQ is used.
OFF
:CINEMA EQ is not used.
D.COMP
Compress dynamic range (difference between loud and soft sounds).
Remote Control
[Selectable items]
OFF
:Turn dynamic range compression off.
Multi-Zone
aSurround Parameter
LOW :Low setting.
Adjust surround sound parameters.
The adjustable parameters differ for the different surround modes
(vpage 64, 65).
MID :Middle setting.
MODE
Information
Select the mode according to the playback source.
nIn the PLgx mode
Troubleshooting
PLgx MUSIC
Compress dynamic range (difference between loud and soft sounds).
PLgx GAME
[Selectable items]
nIn the PLg mode
AUTO :Automatic dynamic range compression on/off control
[Selectable items]
PLg CINEMA PLg MUSIC PLg GAME
according to source.
DOLBY PL
nIn the DTS NEO:6 mode
[Selectable items]
CINEMA
When playing DTS sources, this is only displayed for compatible
software.
DRC
[Selectable items]
PLgx CINEMA
HIGH :High setting.
MUSIC
LOW :Low setting.
MID :Middle setting.
HIGH :High setting.
OFF
:Dynamic range compression always off.
CINEMA : Surround sound mode optimized for movie sources.
MUSIC : Surround sound mode optimized for music sources.
GAME
PL
This can be set in the Dolby TrueHD mode.
: Surround sound mode optimized for games.
: Dolby Pro Logic playback mode.
38
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
42
2007/09/28
11:41:31
ENGLISH
EFFECT
Adjust the low-frequency effects level (LFE).
Switch effect signal for multi-surround speakers on and off.
When “EFFECT” is set to “ON”, a surround effect with a strong sense
of expansion is achieved.
[Variable range] –10dB ~
0dB
[Selectable items]
OFF
LEVEL
Select playback mode for surround back channels.
Adjust effect signal level.
[Selectable items]
~
10
~ 15
1.0
ROOM SIZE
PANORAMA
Determine size of acoustic environment.
Assign front L/R signal also to surround channels, for wider sound.
If the surround effect seems weak, set “PANORAMA” to “ON”.
[Selectable items]
OFF
ON
medium
~
3
~
med. l
large
6
:Simulate acoustics of a large room.
NOTE
CENTER WIDTH
~
3
~
7
DELAY TIME
Adjust delay time to control sound stage size.
[Variable range] 0 ms ~
30 ms
~ 300 ms
AFDM (Auto Flag Detect Mode)
Auto-select surround mode by source.
This function only works for software containing a special identification
signal.
If the software being played is recorded in Dolby Digital EX or DTS-ES,
it is played in 6.1-channels. If not, it is played in 5.1-channels.
[Selectable items]
ON
:The surround channel signals undergo digital
matrix processing and are output from the
surround back channels.
z1
:Decoded in Dolby Pro Logic IIx Cinema mode,
PLIIx CINEMA
surround back signal played.
z2
:Decoded in Dolby Pro Logic IIx Music mode,
PLIIx MUSIC
surround back signal played.
z3
:DTS signal played with digital matrix processing.
ES MTRX
z4
:Signal included in DTS-ES Discrete 6.1-channel
ES DSCRT
sources played.
DSCRT ON :Mode for discrete playback of surround back
signals included in 7.1-channel digital discrete
audio signals (DVD, etc.).
z1:This can be selected when “Surround Back Speaker” is set to
“2spkrs” at the menu “Manual Setup” – “Speaker Setup” –
“Speaker Configuration” setting (vpage 26).
z2:This can be selected when “Surround Back Speaker” is set to
“2spkrs” or “1spkr” at the menu “Manual Setup” – “Speaker
Setup” –“Speaker Configuration” setting.
z3:This can be selected when playing DTS sources.
z4:This can be selected when playing DTS sources including a
discrete 6.1-channel signal identification signal.
Troubleshooting
Assign center channel signal to front left and right channels for wider
sound.
“ROOM SIZE” does not indicate the size of the room in which sources
are played.
MTRX ON
Information
Shift sound image center to front or rear, to adjust playback balance.
[Variable range] 0
:Simulate acoustics of a small room.
med. s
DIMENSION
[Variable range] 0
small
:The same signals as those of the surround
channels are output from the surround back
channels.
Multi-Zone
[Selectable items]
NON MTRX
Remote Control
~
0.3
:No signal is played from the surround back
channels.
Playback
~
[Variable range] 0.0
Set to a lower level if the positioning and sense of phase of the
surround signals seems unnatural.
OFF
Setup
[Variable range] 1
CENTER IMAGE
Assign center channel signal to front left and right channels for wider
sound.
SB CH OUT (for Multi-channel sources)
Connections
For proper playback of the different program sources, we recommend
setting to the values below.
•Dolby Digital sources: “0 dB”
•DTS movie sources: “0 dB”
•DTS music sources: “–10 dB”
ON
Some Dolby Digital EX sources do not include EX flags. If the playback
mode does not switch automatically even when “AFDM” is set to
“ON”, set “SB CH OUT” to “MTRX ON” or “PLIIx CINEMA”.
Getting Started
LFE
OFF
Example : Playing Dolby Digital software (with EX flag)
•When “AFDM” is set to “ON”, the surround mode is automatically
set to the DOLBY D + PLgx C mode.
•To play in the DOLBY DIGITAL EX mode, set “AFDM” to “OFF” and
“SB CH OUT” to “MTRX ON”.
39
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
43
2007/09/28
11:41:33
ENGLISH
Getting Started
SB CH OUT (for 2-channel sources)
Determine whether to use surround back speakers.
sTone Control
dRoom EQ
Adjust the tonal quality of the sound.
Select room equalizer for current environment.
[Selectable items]
Connections
ON
:The surround back channel signal is played.
Tone Defeat
OFF
:The surround back channel signal is not played.
Turn tone adjustments off.
[Selectable items]
Setup
This operation can be performed directly pressing the SURROUND BACK
button on the main unit.
ON
:Playback without tone control.
OFF
:Allow tone control (treble, bass).
Playback
SW ATT (Subwoofer Attenuate)
Attenuate subwoofer level when using EXT. IN mode.
[Selectable items]
Bass
Remote Control
:The input from the subwoofer channel is attenuated.
Adjust low frequency range (bass).
OFF
:The input from the subwoofer channel is not attenuated.
Usually use in this mode.
[Variable range] –6dB ~ +6dB
Treble
Multi-Zone
Adjust high frequency range (treble).
[Variable range] –6dB ~ +6dB
Subwoofer
Information
Turn subwoofer output on and off.
Audyssey
“Bass” and “Treble” can be set when “Tone Defeat” is set to “OFF”.
:Optimize frequency response of all speakers.
Audyssey Byp. L/R :Optimize frequency response of speakers
except front L and R speakers.
Audyssey Flat
:Optimize frequency response of all speakers to
flat response.
Manual
:Apply frequency response set with “Manual
EQ” (vpage 29).
The tone cannot be adjusted when in the DIRECT mode.
ON
Set this to “ON” if the subwoofer channel level seems too high when
playing Super Audio CD.
[Selectable items]
OFF
:Turn equalizer off.
Operating from the main unit or main remote
control unit
Press the ROOM EQ button on the main unit or the EQ button on the
main remote control.
Audyssey
OFF
Manual
When “Audyssey” is selected, “
Audyssey Byp. L/R
Audyssey Flat
” lights.
When “Audyssey Byp. L/R” or “Audyssey Flat” is selected, or when
the auto setup measuring results have changed, “
” lights.
[Selectable items]
Troubleshooting
ON
:The subwoofer is used.
OFF
:The subwoofer is not used.
Default
Resets the settings to the default values.
•“Audyssey”, “Audyssey Byp. L/R” and “Audyssey Flat” can be
selected after the auto setup procedure has been performed.
•If the settings of the speakers for which “None” has been determined
at “Auto Setup” are changed, “Audyssey”, “Audyssey Byp. L/R” and
“Audyssey Flat” cannot be selected and measurements have to be
taken again to include the newly-added speakers.
•When using headphones, “Room EQ” is always set to “OFF”.
40
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
44
2007/09/28
11:41:33
ENGLISH
gNight Mode
This function restores compressed audio signals to how they
were before compression and corrects the sense of volume of
the bass and treble to obtain richer playback sound.
Optimized setting for late-night listening.
:Turn night mode off.
LOW :Low setting.
:
Apply suitable bass and treble boost for all compressed sources.
Mode3 (RESTORER HQ):
OFF
Surround Mode:
STEREO
Input Mode
:ANALOG
1/4
hAudio Delay
aMain Zone
Compensate for mismatched timing between video and audio.
Shows information about settings for main zone.
The items displayed differ according to the input source.
Delay audio.
This sets the delay time for audio signals.
[Variable range] 0 ms
~ 200 ms
If you wish to adjust the “Audio Delay” while playing HDMI or
component video signals, press u to set “OSD” to “OFF”. This way
the audio delay can be adjusted while watching the picture. (Press u
again to switch to the on-screen display.)
Operating from the main unit or main remote
control unit
bWhen set using the procedure below, the on-screen display is not
displayed. Adjust while watching the display.
q Press the AUDIO DELAY button on the main unit or the A. DL button
on the main remote control unit.
w Use the o p button to set.
[Items to be checked]
Select Source
Name Surround Mode Input Mode
Rec Select Video Select
Night Mode
Source Level Room EQ
RESTORER etc.
Troubleshooting
About the RESTORER function
•Such compressed audio formats as MP3, WMA (Windows Media
Audio) and MPEG-4 AAC reduce the amount of data by eliminating
signal components that are hard for the human ear to hear. The
RESTORER function generates the signals eliminated upon
compression, restoring the sound to conditions near those of the
original sound before compression. It also corrects the sense of
volume of the bass to obtain richer sound with compressed audio
signals.
•This is displayed on the menu and can be set when the analog
signals (including AM/FM signals) or PCM signals (fs = 44.1/48
kHz) are input.
Select Source: PHONO
Name
:Record
Information
Mode 2
(RESTORER 96)
5-1.Status
Multi-Zone
During playback, press the RESTORER button on the main unit or the
RSTR button on the main remote control unit.
When set to something other than “OFF”, “
” is displayed.
MID
HIGH
The default setting for “iPod” is “Mode3”. All others are set to “OFF”.
Operating from the main unit or main remote
control unit
LOW
1.Status
2.Audio Input Signal
3.HDMI Information
4.Auto Surround Mode
5.Quick Select
6.Preset Station
Remote Control
Optimized mode for compressed sources with normal highs.
Press the NGT button.
The “
” indicator lights when “LOW”, “MID” or “HIGH” is
selected.
5.Information
Playback
Mode2 (RESTORER 96):
F Menu screen F
Operating from the main remote control unit
Setup
Optimized mode for compressed sources with very weak highs.
Mode 1
(RESTORER 64)
Mode 3
(RESTORER HQ)
Shows information about current settings.
HIGH :High setting.
Mode1 (RESTORER 64):
OFF
Status
MID :Middle setting.
Do not use RESTORER.
Connections
OFF
Information
[Selectable items]
OFF
[Selectable items]
Getting Started
fRESTORER
sZONE2 / ZONE3
Shows information about settings for multi-zone.
[Items to be checked]
Power
Select Source
Volume Level
•This cannot be adjusted when playing in the EXT. IN, DIRECT or
STEREO mode (with “Front Speaker” set to “Large”, “Tone Defeat”
to “ON” and “Room EQ” to “OFF”.)
•The adjustment range is 0 to 100 ms when the Auto Lipsync
Correction function is activated.
41
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
45
2007/09/28
11:41:34
ENGLISH
Getting Started
Audio Input Signal
HDMI Information
Quick Select
Shows information about audio input signals.
Shows information about HDMI input signal and monitor.
Shows information about quick select settings.
F Menu screen F
F Menu screen F
F Menu screen F
5.Information
5.Information
Connections
1.Status
2.Audio Input Signal
3.HDMI Information
4.Auto Surround Mode
5.Quick Select
6.Preset Station
5-2.Audio Input Signal
Surround Mode:
DOLBY DIGITAL EX
Setup
SIGNAL:Dolby Digital
fs
:48kHz
Format:3/2/.1
Offset:-4dB
Playback
[Items to be checked]
Surround Mode : The currently set surround mode is displayed.
Remote Control
SIGNAL
fs
Format
Multi-Zone
Offset
Flag
: The input signal type is displayed.
Information
: The input signal’s sampling frequency is
displayed.
: The number of channels in the input signal (front,
surround, LFE) is displayed.
: The dialogue normalization correction value is
displayed.
: “MATRIX” is displayed if the input signal has
undergone matrix processing, “DISCRETE” if the
input signal has undergone discrete processing.
5.Information
1.Status
2.Audio Input Signal
3.HDMI Information
4.Auto Surround Mode
5.Quick Select
6.Preset Station
5-3.HDMI Signal Info.
Resolution
480p
Color Space
RGB 4:4:4
5-5.Quick Select
1.Quick Select 1
2.Quick Select 2
3.Quick Select 3
Pixel Depth
8bits
1/2
[Items to be checked]
aHDMI Signal Information
The HDMI input signal information is displayed.
Name
Input Source
Analog/PCM 2CH
Input Mode
Multi ch
Volume Level
Digital 2CH
Digital 5.1CH
[Items to be checked]
Resolution Color Space Pixel Depth
For instructions on storing settings at Quick Select 1 to 3, see page
50.
sHDMI Monitor Information
The HDMI monitor information is displayed.
Interface
Preset Station
Shows information about preset stations.
[Items to be checked]
F Menu screen F
Support Resolution
5.Information
Dialogue normalization function
Troubleshooting
This is automatically activated when playing Dolby Digital sources.
This function automatically corrects the standard signal level for
individual program sources.
The correction value can be checked using the STATUS button on
the main unit.
1.Status
2.Audio Input Signal
3.HDMI Information
4.Auto Surround Mode
5.Quick Select
6.Preset Station
Auto Surround Mode
Shows information about auto surround mode settings.
The surround mode for which the last memory function was used
for the different input signal types is displayed.
1.Status
2.Audio Input Signal
3.HDMI Information
4.Auto Surround Mode
5.Quick Select
6.Preset Station
5-6.Preset Station
A1FM 87.50MHz
A2FM 89.10MHz
A3FM 98.10MHz
A4FM108.00MHz
A5FM 90.10MHz
A6FM 90.10MHz
A7FM 90.10MHz
A8FM 90.10MHz
F Menu screen F
5.Information
The figure is the correction value when the standard level is
corrected.
1.Status
2.Audio Input Signal
3.HDMI Information
4.Auto Surround Mode
5.Quick Select
6.Preset Station
5-4.Auto Surround Mode
[Analog][PCM]
2CH:STEREO
[Multi ch]
:MULTI CH IN
[Digital]
2CH:DOLBY PLIIx Cinema
5.1CH:DOLBY/DTS SURROUND
[Input source]
TUNER
[Items to be checked] A1 ~ G8
Operating from the main unit
When the STATUS button on the main unit is pressed, the set’s status
can be checked on the display.
[Items to be checked]
Analog/PCM 2CH
Multi ch
Digital 2CH
Digital 5.1CH
42
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
46
2007/09/28
11:41:36
ENGLISH
SOURCE SELECT
<SOURCE>
MASTER VOLUME
SPEAKER
Playback
Turning the Power On
Press <POWER>.
2
Press <ON/STANDBY> or [POWER ON].
The power indicator flashes green and the power turns on.
To operate the AVR-2808 using the main remote control unit, set the
remote control unit to the AMP mode (vpage 51 “Remote Control
Unit Operations”).
AMP]
Operations During Playback
Adjusting the Master Volume
Either turn <MASTER VOLUME> or press [MASTER
VOLUME].
Turning Off the Sound Temporarily (Muting)
Press [MUTE].
[POWER ON]
MASTER VOLUME
SOURCE SELECT
NOTE
Power continues to be supplied to some of the circuitry even when
the power is in the standby mode. When leaving home for long periods
of time or when traveling, either press <POWER> to turn off the power,
or unplug the power cord from the power outlet.
Listening with Headphones
Plug the headphones into <PHONES>.
The sound from the speakers and pre-out connectors is automatically
cut.
NOTE
Be careful not to set the volume too high when using headphones.
Selecting the Input Source
Operation on the Main Unit
Turn <SOURCE SELECT>.
Troubleshooting
[MUTE]
[POWER OFF]
To cancel, press [MUTE] again. Muting can also be canceled by adjusting
the master volume.
Information
SPEAKER
qPress <ON/STANDBY> or [POWER OFF].
The power is set to the standby mode.
wPress <POWER>.
The power indicator turns off, and so does the power.
Multi-Zone
Turning the Power Off
Remote Control
[
<PHONES>
To operate the AVR-2808 using the main remote control unit, set the
remote control unit to the AMP mode (vpage 51 “Remote Control
Unit Operations”).
Playback
<POWER>
<ON/STANDBY>
The power indicator lights red and the power is set to the standby
mode.
The desired input source can be selected directly.
Setup
1
Press [SOURCE SELECT].
Connections
Preparations
Getting Started
Operation on the Main Remote Control Unit
Switching the Front Speakers
Press SPEAKER.
Front A
Front B
Front A+B
About the button names in these explanations
< > : Buttons on the main unit
[
] : Buttons on the remote control unit
Button name only:
Buttons on the main unit and remote control unit
If “Rec Select” or “Video Select” is selected for the input source,
press <SOURCE> before turning <SOURCE SELECT>.
43
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
47
2007/09/28
11:41:37
ENGLISH
Getting Started
Playing Video and Audio Equipment
SOURCE SELECT
Basic Operation
1
Prepare the equipment.
Connections
Setup
qLoad the DVD, CD or other software in the player.
(vSee the operating instructions of the respective devices.)
wTo play a video device, switch the monitor input.
(vSee the monitor’s operating instructions.)
Playback
2
To operate using the main remote control unit, set the
<TUNING PRESET>
remote control unit to the AMP mode.
(vpage 51 “Remote Control Unit Operations”)
3
4
Remote Control
Use SOURCE SELECT to select the input source.
[
TU]
(
Multi-Zone
[BAND]
[MODE]
[df]
Listening to FM/AM Broadcasts
[MEMO]
Information
Basic Operation
[SEARCH]
Either turn
Troubleshooting
[CHANNEL]
[TUNER]
(AMP mode),
[SHIFT]
1
2
[1 ~ 8],
SOURCE SELECT
(AMP mode)
1
2
3
Press [MEMO].
Press [A ~ G] to select the block in which the station is
to be preset, then press [CHANNEL] or [1 ~ 8] to select
the preset number.
bThe memory block can also be selected by pressing [SHIFT].
<SOURCE SELECT> or press [TUNER]
(AMP mode) to select “TUNER”.
4
Press [MEMO] again to complete the setting.
To operate using the main remote control unit, set the
remote control unit to the TUNER (
) mode.
(vpage 51 “Remote Control Unit Operations”)
3
4
Press [BAND] to select “FM” or “AM”.
Tune in the desired broadcast station.
About the button names in these explanations
< > : Buttons on the main unit
[
] : Buttons on the remote control unit
Button name only:
Buttons on the main unit and remote control unit
Your favorite broadcast stations can be preset so that you can tune
them in easily. Up to 56 stations can be preset.
(vSee the operating instructions of the respective devices.)
[A ~ G]
Presetting Radio Stations
(Preset Memory)
Tune in the broadcast station you want to preset.
Start playback.
mode)
•It is also possible to switch to “FM” or “AM” in step 1 by pressing
[TUNER].
•If the desired station cannot be tuned in with auto tuning, tune it in
manually.
•When tuning in stations manually, press and hold [df] to change
frequencies continuously.
•The time for which the menus are displayed can be set at menu
“Manual Setup” – “Option Setup” – “On-Screen Display” (vpage
31, 32).
•To preset other stations, repeat steps 1 to 4.
•Stations can be preset automatically at menu “Input Setup” – “Auto
Preset” (vpage 34).
NOTE
Preset stations are erased by overwriting them.
qTo tune in automatically (Auto Tuning)
Press [MODE] to light the “AUTO” indicator on the display, then use
[df] to select the station you want to hear.
wTo tune in manually (Manual Tuning)
Press [MODE] to turn off the display’s “AUTO” indicator, then use
[df] to select the station you want to hear.
44
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
48
2007/09/28
11:41:38
ENGLISH
Operation on the Main Unit
Operation on the Main Remote Control Unit
channel.
Auto tuner presets
PTY identifies the type of RDS program.
The program types and their displays are as follows:
522 / 603 / 999 / 1404 / 1611 kHz,
90.1 / 90.1 / 90.1 MHz
C1 ~ C8
90.1 MHz
D1 ~ D8
90.1 MHz
E1 ~ E8
90.1 MHz
EASY M
F1 ~ F8
90.1 MHz
G1 ~ G8
90.1 MHz
LIGHT M
CLASSICS
OTHER M
Weather
Finance
Children’s
CHILDREN
programmes
SOCIAL
Social Affairs
RELIGION
Religion
PHONE IN
Phone In
TRAVEL
Travel
LEISURE
Leisure
JAZZ
Jazz Music
COUNTRY
Country Music
NATION M
National Music
OLDIES
Oldies Music
FOLK M
Folk Music
DOCUMENT Documentary
WEATHER
FINANCE
remote control unit to the TUNER (
) mode.
(vpage 51 “Remote Control Unit Operations”)
3
4
Press [SEARCH] to select “RDS”.
Press [CHANNEL].
The search for RDS stations begins automatically.
bIf no RDS stations are found with the above operation, all the
reception bands are searched.
bWhen a broadcast station is found, that station’s name appears on
the display.
5
To continue searching, repeat steps 2 to 3.
bIf no RDS station is found when all the frequencies have been
searched, “NO RDS” is displayed.
Information
B1 ~ B8
<SOURCE SELECT> or press [TUNER]
(AMP mode) to select “TUNER”.
Multi-Zone
A1 ~ A8
87.5 / 89.1 / 98.1 / 108.0 / 90.1 / 90.1 / 90.1 /
90.1 MHz
News
Current Affairs
Information
Sports
Education
Drama
Culture
Science
Varied
Pop Music
Rock Music
Easy Listening
Music
Light Classical
Serious Classical
Other Music
Either turn
To operate using the main remote control unit, set the
Program Type (PTY)
NEWS
AFFAIRS
INFO
SPORT
EDUCATE
DRAMA
CULTURE
SCIENCE
VARIED
POP M
ROCK M
1
2
Remote Control
nDefault settings
Use this function to automatically tune to FM stations that
provide the RDS service.
Playback
Press [CHANNEL] or [1 ~ 8] to select the desired preset
RDS (works only on the FM band) is a broadcasting service
which allows a station to send additional information along
with the regular radio program signal.
The following three types of RDS information can be
received with this unit:
Setup
1
2
Press [A ~ G] to select the memory block.
RDS Search
Connections
Press <TUNING PRESET>, then turn <SOURCE SELECT>
to select the preset radio station.
RDS (Radio Data System)
Getting Started
Listening to Preset Stations
Troubleshooting
Traffic Program (TP)
TP identifies programs that carry traffic announcements.
This allows you to easily find out the latest traffic conditions in your
area before leaving home.
Radio Text (RT)
RT allows RDS stations to send text messages that appear on the
display.
NOTE
The operations described below using [SEARCH] will not function in
areas in which there are no RDS broadcasts.
45
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
49
2007/09/28
11:41:38
ENGLISH
Getting Started
<SOURCE SELECT>
uiop
PTY Search
TP Search
Use this function to find RDS stations broadcasting a
designated program type (PTY).
For a description of each program type, refer to “Program
Type (PTY)”.
Use this function to find RDS stations broadcasting traffic
programs (TP stations).
Connections
1
2
Either turn
<SOURCE SELECT> or press [TUNER]
(AMP mode) to select “TUNER”.
Setup
Playback
<ON/STANDBY>
Remote Control
[
TU]
(
mode)
Multi-Zone
Information
ENTER
uiop
[SEARCH]
Troubleshooting
[CHANNEL]
[TUNER]
ENTER
3
4
5
remote control unit to the TUNER (
) mode.
(vpage 51 “Remote Control Unit Operations”)
Press [SEARCH] to select “PTY”.
Watching the display, press ui to call out the desired
[ iPod]
[8],
[9],
[6],
[7],
[1], [2]
ENTER
uiop
[SEARCH]
[CHANNEL
+/–]
Either turn
<SOURCE SELECT> or press [TUNER]
(AMP mode) to select “TUNER”.
To operate using the main remote control unit, set the
To operate using the main remote control unit, set the
1
2
program type.
Press [CHANNEL].
PTY search begins automatically.
bIf there is no station broadcasting the designated program type
with the above operation, all the reception bands are searched.
bThe station name is displayed on the display after searching
stops.
remote control unit to the TUNER (
) mode.
(vpage 51 “Remote Control Unit Operations”)
3
4
Press [SEARCH] to select “TP”.
Press [CHANNEL].
TP search begins automatically.
bIf no TP station is found with the above operation, all the reception
bands are searched.
bThe station name is displayed on the display after searching
stops.
5
To continue searching, repeat steps 2 to 3.
bIf no other TP station is found when all the frequencies have been
searched, “NO PROGRAMME” is displayed.
6
To continue searching, repeat steps 2 to 4.
bIf no station broadcasting the designated program type is found
when all the frequencies have been searched, “NO PROGRAMME”
is displayed.
[iPod]
(AMP mode)
(AMP mode)
About the button names in these explanations
< > : Buttons on the main unit
[
] : Buttons on the remote control unit
Button name only:
Buttons on the main unit and remote control unit
46
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
50
2007/09/28
11:41:39
ENGLISH
“RT” appears on the display when radio text data is
received.
Either turn
To operate using the main remote control unit, set the
remote control unit to the TUNER (
) mode.
(vpage 51 “Remote Control Unit Operations”)
Press [SEARCH] to select “RT”.
b The iPod may only be used to copy or play contents that are not
copyrighted or contents for which copying or playback is legally
permitted for your private use as an individual. Be sure to comply
with applicable copyright legislation.
Basic Operation
Make the necessary preparations.
qSet the iPod in the DENON Control Dock for iPod.
(vSee the Control Dock for iPod’s operating instructions.)
w Assign the Control Dock for iPod’s input.
MENU : ”Input Setup” – “Assign” – ”iPod dock”
mode) to select the input source assigned in step 1-w
above.
ui to select the menu, then press ENTER or p
to select the music file to be played.
Use
Press ENTER or p.
Playback starts.
Information
2
Either turn <SOURCE SELECT> or press [iPod] (AMP
1
2
Multi-Zone
(vpage 35)
Listening to Music
Stopping playback temporarily
During playback, press ENTER or [1].
Press again to resume playback.
Fast-forwarding or fast-reversing
(iPod screen)
b If the screens above are not displayed, the iPod may not be
properly connected. Try connecting again.
3
To operate using the main remote control unit, set the
remote control unit to the iPod mode.
(vpage 51 “Remote Control Unit Operations”)
To cue to the beginning of a track
During playback, either press u (to cue to the previous track) or i (to
cue to the next track), or press [8] or [9].
Troubleshooting
During playback, either press and hold u (to fast-reverse) or i (to fastforward), or press [6] or [7].
OK to disconnect.
Remote Control
1
NOTE
• Depending on the type of iPod and the software version, some
functions may not operate.
• DENON will accept no responsibility whatsoever for any loss of iPod
data.
Playback
b While receiving an RDS broadcast station, the text data broadcast
from the station is displayed.
b To turn the display off, press op.
b If no text data is being broadcast, “NO TEXT DATA” is displayed.
iPod is a trademark of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S.
and other countries.
Setup
3
<SOURCE SELECT> or press [TUNER]
(AMP mode) to select “TUNER”.
• With the default settings, the iPod can be used connected to the VCR
(iPod) connector.
• Use the RESTORER mode to expand the low and high frequency
components of compressed audio files and achieve a richer sound.
The default setting is “Mode3”.
• Press <ON/STANDBY> and set the AVR-2808’s power to the standby
mode before disconnecting the iPod. Also switch the input source
to one to which the menu “iPod dock” is not assigned before
disconnecting the iPod.
Connections
1
2
The music on an iPod can be played by using the Control Dock for
iPod (ASD-1R, sold separately).
The operation can also be performed using the buttons on the main
unit or remote control unit while watching the menus.
Getting Started
iPod® Playback
RT (Radio Text)
To stop
During playback, either press and hold ENTER or press [2].
Playing repeatedly
Press [CHANNEL –].
[Selectable items] All
One
OFF
MENU : ”Input Setup” – ”iPod” – “Repeat” (vpage 35)
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
51
2007/09/28
11:41:41
ENGLISH
Getting Started
Shuffling playback
Press [CHANNEL +].
[Selectable items] Albums Songs
Surround mode
<SOURCE SELECT>
OFF
uiop
<STATUS>
MENU : ”Input Setup” – ”iPod” – “Shuffle” (vpage 36)
Other Operations and
Functions
Connections
Searching up or down pages
Press [SEARCH], then press o (down) or p (up).
To cancel, press ui or [SEARCH].
Other Operations
To switch between the Browse and Remote modes
Setup
Either press and hold [SEARCH].
Playing Super Audio CD
Playback
Remote Control
• The title name, artist name and album name can be checked by
pressing <STATUS> during playback.
• On the AVR-2808, folder and file names can be displayed as titles. Any
characters that cannot be displayed are replaced with “ . (period)”.
• The time for which the menus are displayed can be set at menu
“Manual Setup” – “Option Setup” – “On-Screen Display” – “iPod
Information” (vpage 32).
INPUT MODE
<ZONE2/3 / REC SELECT> CH SELECT
[
Multi-Zone
Information
Photo and video data on the iPod can be viewed on the monitor.
Only for iPod equipped with slideshow or video functions. (When
using an ASD-1R)
Troubleshooting
1
2
3
Press and hold [SEARCH] to set the Remote mode.
“Remote iPod” is displayed on the AVR-2808’s display.
Watching the iPod’s screen, use
Assign the HDMI input connector at the “HDMI”
setting (vpage 35).
<SOURCE SELECT> or press [SOURCE
to select the input source assigned in step 1.
Either turn
The “
AMP]
Viewing Still Pictures or Videos on the
iPod
1
2 SELECT]
3
” indicator lights on the display.
Use INPUT MODE to select “AUTO” (vpage 34).
Surround mode
INPUT MODE
4
5
Select the input mode according to the program source to be
played.
Select the surround mode (vpage 36 ~ 38).
We recommend playing in the DIRECT mode.
Start playing the Super Audio CD.
CH SELECT
uiop
The “
” indicator lights on the display.
For operating instructions, refer to the respective equipment’s
operating instructions.
ui to select
“Photos” or “Videos”.
Press
ENTER until the image you want to view is
displayed.
[SOURCE SELECT]
“TV Out” at the iPod’s “Slideshow Settings” or “Video Settings” must
be set to “On” in order to display the iPod’s photo data or videos on
the monitor. For details, see the iPod’s operating instructions.
• When playing DSD signals in the DIRECT or PURE DIRECT mode,
the DSD signals are converted as such into analog signals. When
playing in other surround modes, the DSD signals are first converted
into PCM format, then into analog signals.
• “DSD DIRECT” is shown on the display when playing DSD 2-channel
signals in the DIRECT mode. “DSD MULTI DIRECT” is shown on
the display when playing DSD multi--channel signals in the DIRECT
mode.
About the button names in these explanations
< > : Buttons on the main unit
[
]
: Buttons on the remote control unit
Button name only:
Buttons on the main unit and remote control unit
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
52
2007/09/28
11:41:42
ENGLISH
You can listen to one program source while recording a different
program source.
Press <ZONE2/3 / REC SELECT>.
ZONE2 SOURCE
ZONE2 TUNER
RECOUT V. AUX
······
····
RECOUT TUNER
ZONE2 V. AUX
RECOUT SOURCE
The “
Turn
” indicator lights.
<SOURCE SELECT> to choose the input source
Press ui or CH SELECT to select “Fader”.
Convenient Functions
Use o p to adjust the volume of the speakers.
Channel Level
You can adjust the channel level either according to the playback
sources or to suit your taste, as described below.
1
Press CH SELECT.
Channel Volume
FL
C
FR
SW
to be recorded.
Press CH SELECT.
0.0dB
0.0dB
0.0dB
0.0dB
SR
SBR
SBL
SL
0.0dB
0.0dB
0.0dB
0.0dB
(o: front, p: rear)
•The fader function does not affect the subwoofer.
•The fader can be adjusted until the volume of the speaker adjusted
to the lowest value is –12 dB.
Play the program source.
For operating instructions, refer to the respective equipment’s
operating instructions.
Use ui or CH SELECT to select the speaker.
The speaker that can be set switches each time one of the
buttons is pressed.
3
Use o p to adjust the volume.
Troubleshooting
•To cancel, press <ZONE2/3 / REC SELECT>, then turn <SOURCE SELECT>
until “ZONE2 SOURCE” is displayed.
• Make a test recording before starting the actual recording.
• Signals are only output to the analog REC OUT connectors when
the digital signals input to the digital input connectors (OPTICAL/
COAXIAL) are PCM (2-channel) signals.
•Digital audio signals input to the HDMI connectors are not output
to the REC OUT connectors, so connect using the OPTICAL or
COAXIAL connectors.
•Sources selected with the REC OUT mode are output from ZONE2
as well.
•In the REC OUT mode, the remote control unit’s ZONE2 mode
buttons cannot be operated.
2
Information
Start recording.
Fader
FRONT : REAR
Multi-Zone
5
For operating instructions, refer to the respective equipment’s
operating instructions.
To record FM or AM broadcasts, select the broadcast (vpage
44).
Remote Control
3
4
is displayed.
1
2
3
Playback
Turn <SOURCE SELECT> until “RECOUT SOURCE”
This function lets you adjust (fade) the sound from all the front or
rear speakers at once.
Setup
2
“ZONE2 SOURCE” is shown on the display.
Fader Function
Connections
1
NOTE
•Recordings you make are for your personal enjoyment and should
not be used for other purposes without permission of the copyright
holder.
•Input sources for which “Delete” is selected at “Source Delete”cannot
be selected.
Getting Started
Recording on an External Device
(REC OUT mode)
b“OFF” can be set by pressing o when the subwoofer’s volume is
set to –12 dB.
49
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
53
2007/09/28
11:41:43
ENGLISH
Getting Started
<STANDARD> <DSP SIMULATION>
Quick Select Function
Last Function Memory
With this function, the currently playing input source, input mode,
surround mode, room EQ settings and volume can be stored in
the memory.
This stores the settings as they were directly before the standby
mode was set.
When the power is turned back on, the settings are restored to as
they were directly before the standby mode was set.
1
Connections
Set the input source, input mode, surround mode,
2
room EQ settings and volume to the conditions you
want to store.
Setup
Press and hold the desired QUICK SELECT.
Playback
<POWER>
Keep pressing the button until the quick select indicator lights.
QUICK SELECT
Remote Control
Input Source
DVD
TV/CBL
VCR
Volume
–40 dB
–40 dB
–40 dB
Multi-Zone
•To call out the settings, press QUICK SELECT at which the desired
settings were stored.
• The Quick Select name can be changed (vpage 32).
NOTE
Information
Input sources stored with the quick select function cannot be selected
if they have been deleted at menu “Manual Setup” – “Option Setup”
– “Source Delete” (vpage 31). In this case, store them again.
Troubleshooting
Personal Memory Plus Function
This function sets the settings (input mode, surround mode, etc.)
last selected for the individual input sources.
When you switch to an input source, the settings are automatically
set to the ones that were set the last time that input source was
used.
About the button names in these explanations
< > : Buttons on the main unit
[
] : Buttons on the remote control unit
Button name only:
Buttons on the main unit and remote control unit
The various settings are backed up for about 1 week, even if the
power is turned off or the power cord is disconnected.
[Quick Select Defaults]
Quick Select 1
Quick Select 2
Quick Select 3
QUICK SELECT
Backup Memory
Resetting the Microprocessor
Perform this procedure if the display is abnormal or if operations
cannot be performed.
When the microprocessor is reset, all the settings are reset to
their default values.
<POWER>
1
<POWER>
2 <STANDARD>
<DSP SIMULATION>
3
Turn off the power using
Press
and
.
while simultaneously pressing
.
Once the display starts flashing at intervals of about 1
second, release the two buttons.
If in step 3 the display does not flash at intervals of about 1 second,
start over from step 1.
The surround parameters, tone control, room EQ settings and the
volumes of the different speakers are stored for the individual surround
modes.
50
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
54
2007/09/28
11:41:44
ENGLISH
Remote Control Unit Operations
1
Press
:TUNER (FM/AM)
: iPod
:NET/USB /
DIGITAL TUNER
: DVD player (Recorder) /
CD player (Recorder)
: VCR / TAPE
:Satellite Receiver / Cable TV
: TV
Press
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
GAMP modeH
GZONE2 modeH
brand of the component to be preset. The numbers
are shown in the Preset Code Table (vEnd of this
manual).
When the code is registered, the signal transmission indicator
flashes twice.
When the preset code is transmitted, the mode indicator for the
component to which that code belongs flashes.
GZONE3 modeH
bThe input mode is canceled if no button is operated for 10
seconds.
GSYSTEM CALL modeH
1
Press
GZONE4 modeH
[MODE SELECTOR] for the component to be
operated.
Troubleshooting
[HOME]
The mode indicator of the device to be operated flashes.
2
[NUMBER]
Operate the component.
[RC SETUP]
Information
Operating Preset Components
Multi-Zone
Some brands have more than one preset code. If the component does
not operate, try inputting a different code.
Remote Control
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
Press [NUMBER] and input the 5-digit number of the
bThe mode switches each time [AMP] is pressed.
[MODE SELECTOR]
[MODE SELECTOR] for the device you want to
preset.
Playback
bThe TUNER (
), NET/DTU (
and
) mode is not
used on the AVR-2808, so use the learn function to store the signals
(vpage 54).
1
2
3
Setup
AMP]
The indicator for the component to be operated flashes.
The included main remote control unit can be preset to operate
devices of various brands.
Connections
[
Signal transmission
indicator
operated.
:AMP / ZONE2 / ZONE3 /
ZONE4 / SYSTEM CALL
Main Remote Control Unit
•On the main remote control unit, the display switches according
to the device being operated and the mode.
•In modes other than iPod, the mode switches between“
”
and “
” each time the [MODE SELECTOR] is pressed.
•In the AMP, TUNER and iPod modes, when the remote ID is set,
the AVR-2808 can be used independently even in an environment
containing multiple DENON amplifiers.
[MODE SELECTOR] for the component to be
Presetting
Getting Started
Operating DENON Audio Components
bFor details, refer to the component’s operating instructions.
2
Operate the component.
Depending on the model and year of manufacture of your equipment,
some buttons may not operate.
bFor details, refer to the component’s operating instructions.
NOTE
The device mode (“
setting is being made.
” or “
”) cannot be changed while the
[HOME] is used to return to the AMP mode (AMP, ZONE2, ZONE3,
ZONE4 or SYSTEM CALL) when in any mode other than AMP.
51
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
55
2007/09/28
11:41:46
ENGLISH
Getting Started
Functions of Buttons by Component
EL Display
EL Display
Connections
[MODE
SELECTOR]
Setup
Playback
[MENU]
Remote Control
[SETUP/
SEARCH]
Multi-Zone
[CH + /
SHUFFLE],
[CH – /
REPEAT]
Buttons
MODE SELECTOR
[1],
[8 9],
[6 7], [3],
[2],
[SOURCE ON],
[SOURCE OFF]
[ENTER]
[uiop]
[RETURN]
DVD
VCR
iPod
Device Mode
Device operated
1
8 9
6 7
DVD
(Default setting)
Playback
Auto search
(cue)
Manual search
(fast-reverse/
fast-forward)
CD Recorder
VCR
TAPE
iPod
Playback
Auto search
(cue)
Manual search
(fast-reverse/
fast-forward)
CD
(Default setting)
Playback
Auto search
(cue)
Manual search
(fast-reverse/
fast-forward)
Playback
Auto search
(cue)
Manual search
(fast-reverse/
fast-forward)
Playback
Auto search
(cue)
Manual search
(fast-reverse/
fast-forward)
Playback
Auto search
(cue)
Manual search
(fast-reverse/
fast-forward)
Playback/Pause
Auto search
(cue)
Manual search
(fast-reverse/
fast-forward)
DVD Recorder
Information
Troubleshooting
3
Pause
Pause
Pause
Pause
Pause
Pause
–
2
SOURCE ON
SOURCE OFF
Stop
Power on
Power off
Stop
Power on
Power off
Stop
–
–
Stop
–
–
Stop
Power on
Power off
Stop
–
–
Stop
–
–
MENU
u i o p
ENTER
Menu/guide
Cursor
Enter setting
Menu/guide
Cursor
Enter setting
–
–
–
–
–
–
Menu/guide
Cursor
Enter setting
–
–
–
SETUP/SEARCH
Set up
Set up
–
–
Set up
–
RETURN
Return
Return
–
–
Cancel
–
CH + / SHUFFLE
–
–
–
–
Switch channels
–
CH – / REPEAT
–
–
–
–
Switch channels
–
0 ~ 9, +10
Special Remarks
Select track
Select track
Select track
Select track
–
q
–
q
Menu
Cursor
Enter
Page forward
screen / Browse/
Remote mode
switching (Press
and hold)
Return
1-track/album
shuffle play
1-track/All-track
repeat play
–
–
Buttons
[0 ~ 9, +10]
q, w
q
GSpecial RemarksH
qOnly one component can be preset for each mode. If a new code is preset, the previous code is automatically cleared.
wThe names of the functions for the DVD remote control buttons differ from brand to brand. Check beforehand.
NOTE
•Preset a DVD player or DVD recorder for the DVD (
) mode. Preset a CD player or CD recorder for the DVD (
•Preset a VCR for the VCR (
) mode. Preset a tape deck for the VCR (
) mode.
) mode.
52
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
56
2007/09/28
11:41:47
ENGLISH
[MODE
SELECTOR]
[0 ~ 9, +10]
[TV/VCR]
TV (SONY)
SAT
SAT
Punch through
Punch through
Punch through
Punch through
Power on
Power off
Power on
Power off
Power on
Power off
MENU
u i o p
ENTER
SETUP
DISPLAY
CH + / –
0 ~ 9, +10
TV/VCR
Special Remarks
Menu/guide
Cursor
Enter setting
Set up
Display
Switch channels
Channel selection
Switch inputs
q, e
Power on
Power off
Buttons
Menu/guide
Cursor
Enter setting
Set up
Display
Switch channels
Channel selection
Switch inputs
q, e
Menu/guide
Cursor
Enter setting
Set up
Display
Switch channels
Channel selection
–
q, e
Menu/guide
Cursor
Enter setting
Set up
Display
Switch channels
Channel selection
–
q, e
EL Display
[MODE
SELECTOR]
EL Display
[SEARCH]
[CH +/–]
[1 ~ 8]
TU
Troubleshooting
[A ~ G], [d f],
[BAND],
[MODE],
[MEMO]
MODE SELECTOR
Device Mode
Device operated
A~G
d f
BAND
MODE
MEMO
SEARCH
CH + / –
1~8
SHIFT
Information
GSpecial RemarksH
qOnly one component can be preset for each mode. If a new code is preset, the previous code is automatically cleared.
eThe CD, VCR or DVD buttons (one only set) can be assigned to the TV, satellite receiver and cable TV mode (vpage 55 “Punch Through
Function”).
Multi-Zone
Buttons
TV (HITACHI)
Remote Control
[CH +/–]
Device operated
1
8 9
6 7
3
2
SOURCE ON
SOURCE OFF
Playback
[ENTER]
[uiop]
[DISPLAY]
Satellite Receiver / Cable TV
Device Mode
Setup
[SETUP]
[1],
[8 9],
[6 7], [3],
[2],
[SOURCE ON],
[SOURCE OFF]
TV
Connections
[MENU]
MODE SELECTOR
Getting Started
EL Display
EL Display
Analog tuner
Preset memory block selection
Tuning + / –
AM/FM switching
Switch search modes
Preset memory registration
Buttons
RDS search
Preset channel selection
Preset channel selection (1 ~ 8)
Switch memory block
[SHIFT]
Buttons
53
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
57
2007/09/28
11:41:48
ENGLISH
Getting Started
[
AMP]
[
TU]
[SYSTEM CALL]
Signal transmission
indicator
[MODE SELECTOR]
[ iPod]
3
Refer to the table at the below, and use [NUMBER] to
input the 5-digit number corresponding to the remote
ID to be changed.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
Connections
4
5
Press
[TU] (
to be set.
mode) or [iPod] to select the mode
4
Press the button to be set.
The main remote control unit’s display turns off.
bIf a button that cannot be learned is pressed, the signal transmission
indicator lights but the signal is not learned.
5
Point the main remote control units directly at each
Repeat steps 2 to 4 to set the remote IDs for all
Setup
[POWER ON]
Playback
Remote Control
1
(Default)
81001
2
3
4
[RC SETUP]
iPod
(Analog TUNER)
Remote ID
[NUMBER]
Other device’s
remote control unit
TUNER
AMP (MAIN)
[CHANNEL +/–]
52863
72815
82001
52795
72816
83001
52800
72817
84001
52805
72818
Multi-Zone
NOTE
Information
[
TV]
Troubleshooting
[8], [9],
[6], [7],
[1], [3], [2]
Setting the Remote ID
When using multiple DENON AV receivers in the same room,
make this setting so that only the desired AV receiver operates.
1
2
Press [AMP] to set the main remote control unit to the
AMP mode.
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
•When changing a setting, be sure to set the same remote ID as the
AVR-2808’s (vpage 32).
•When changing the AMP mode’s remote ID, also change the
“TUNER” and “iPod” remote ID at the same time.
•Set the remote ID of an analog tuner for TUNER (
).
Learning Function
If your AV devices are of a brand other than DENON or if they
cannot be operated with the preset memory function, their
remote control signals can be transfered to stored in the AVR2808’s main remote control unit.
1
2
3
Once learning is completed normally, the display lights and the
signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
modes.
MODE SELECTOR
Press
set.
other and press and hold the button on the other
device’s remote control unit that you want to learn.
[MODE SELECTOR] for the device you want to
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
AVR-2808’s main remote
control unit (RC-1068)
bIf you want to learn other buttons, repeat steps 4 and 5.
bThe mode can be switched by pressing [MODE SELECTOR].
bThe signal transmission indicator lights once for a long time if
learning was not possible
6
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice and the setting
is completed.
•With some remote control units, the signals cannot be learned or the
device will not operate properly even when the signals have been
learned. In this case, use the device’s own remote control unit.
•Learned buttons have priority over the preset memory. If you no
longer need the learned setting, reset the learning function (vpage
56).
NOTE
•[HOME] cannot be learned.
•Do not learn any remote control signals at [RC SETUP].
•The AMP, ZONE2, ZONE3, ZONE4 and SYSTEM CALL modes cannot
be learned.
Press [9], [7] and [5], in that order.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice and the learning
mode is set.
54
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
58
2007/09/28
11:41:49
ENGLISH
[MODE SELECTOR] for the device you want to
register.
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
Press [9], [7] and [8], in that order.
Press [SYSTEM CALL] (1, 2 or 3) at which you want to
register the signals.
Press the buttons you want to register in the same
6
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice and the backlight
on time setting mode is set.
3
Set the light on time.
Punch Through Function
CD, DVD or VCR mode buttons can be stored at unused TV
or SAT/CBL mode buttons.
For example, when DVD mode buttons are assigned to
the TV mode, the DVD mode operations can be performed
while in the TV mode.
1
2
3
[MODE SELECTOR] for the device you want to
punch through (CD, DVD or VCR).
Press
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
Press [9], [8] and [4], in that order.
4
5
6
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice and the punch
through setting mode is set.
Press the button you want to punch through (1, 2,
6, 7, 8, 9 or 3).
[MODE SELECTOR] for the device you want to
punch through (TV or SAT/CBL).
Press
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
[Settable times] :[1] : 5 sec.
[2] : 10 sec. (Default)
[3] : 15 sec.
[4] : 20 sec.
[5] : 25 sec.
Adjusting the Backlight’s Brightness
The display’s brightness can be adjusted in 5 steps.
(Default: Step 3)
1
2
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
Press [CHANNEL +] or [CHANNEL –].
The display gets one step brighter when [+] is pressed.
The display gets one step darker when [–] is pressed.
3
Press [RC SETUP] to complete the setting.
Troubleshooting
The signal transmission indicator lights when a button is
pressed.
Example :Press [POWER ON].
↓
Press [MODE SELECTOR] – [DVD].
↓
Press [1].
bThe mode can be switched by pressing [MODE SELECTOR].
bPerform the registration procedure for all the buttons you want to
register.
Press [9], [7] and [3], in that order.
Information
sequence as the operations you want to perform.
The registered signals are transmitted in the registered
sequence.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
Multi-Zone
4
5
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice and the system
call registration mode is set.
were registered.
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
Remote Control
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
[SYSTEM CALL] (1, 2 or 3) at which the signals
1
2
Playback
1
2
3
Press
Press
Setting the Time the Backlight Stays Lit
Setup
Registering
1
2
Press [AMP], to select “SYSTEM CALL”.
Connections
This function lets you register a series of operations at a single
button.
For example, the amplifier can be turned on, the input source
selected, the monitor’s power turned on, the source device’s
power turned on and the play mode set all by pressing a single
button.
Up to 32 signals each can be registered at [SYSTEM CALL] (1, 2
or 3).
Calling out
Getting Started
System Call Function
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice and the setting
is completed.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice and the setting
is completed.
55
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
59
2007/09/28
11:41:50
ENGLISH
Getting Started
Signal transmission
indicator
[MODE SELECTOR]
GResetting by device modeH
1
2
3
4
Press
reset.
[MODE SELECTOR] for the device you want to
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
[SYSTEM CALL]
Connections
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
All Settings
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
1
2
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
Press [9], [8] and [1], in that order.
The signal transmission indicator flashes 4 times.
All the settings are restored to their defaults.
Press [9], [7] and [6], in that order.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
Setup
Press
[MODE SELECTOR] for the device you want to
reset twice.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
Playback
Remote Control
System Call Function
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
[NUMBER]
[RC SETUP]
Multi-Zone
Information
1
2
3
4
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
Press [9], [7] and [8], in that order.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
Press [SYSTEM CALL] (1, 2 or 3) you want to reset.
Resetting the Main Remote Control Unit
Learning Function
GResetting button by buttonH
Troubleshooting
1
2
3
4
Press
reset.
[MODE SELECTOR] for the device you want to
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
Press [9], [7] and [6], in that order.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
Press the button you want to reset twice.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
Punch-Through Function
Press [MODE SELECTOR] for the device you want to
reset (TV or SAT/CBL).
1
2
3
4
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
Press [9], [8] and [4], in that order.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
56
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
60
2007/09/28
11:41:51
ENGLISH
[RANDOM]
The amp assign function lets you assign the amplifiers for the different channels built into the AVR-2808 to
the speaker outputs for the different zones.
Select the desired playback environment from among “Setting 1” to “Setting 4”, then set the corresponding
“Amp Assign” mode at menu “Manual Setup” – “Option Setup” – “Amp Assign” (vpage 31).
Connect the speakers as described at “Amp Assign” mode settings and speakers connected to the various
speaker terminals.
Information
“Setting 2” is possible to switch the Amp Assign mode between the 5.1-channel mode and 2-channel
mode without changing the speaker connections.
Multi-Zone
Troubleshooting
Switching the zone to be operated
Power off
Power on
Switching the input source
Volume control
Channel + / –
Tuning + / –
Muting
Switching the memory block
Auto search (cue)
Stop
Play / Pause
1-track / All -track repeat play
1-track / album shuffle play
Multi-zone Settings with the Amp Assign Function
Remote Control
ZONE SELECT
POWER OFF
POWER ON
SOURCE SELECT
VOLUME + / –
CHANNEL + / –
TUNING + / –
MUTE
SHIFT
8 9
2
1/3
REPEAT
RANDOM
[VOLUME+ / –]
[MUTE]
[SHIFT]
NOTE
•For bi-amp playback, use speakers compatible with that type of connection.
•When conducting bi-amp playback, remove the short-circuiting boards (or wires) from the speaker
terminals.
Playback
[CHANNEL+ / –]
[TUNING+ / –]
[8],[9],
[1/3],[2]
[REPEAT]
[POWER ON]
[SOURCE SELECT]
The AVR-2808 is compatible with the following types of playback:
•Multi-zone playback (ZONE2 & ZONE3)
•Bi-amp playback (front speakers)
Setup
[ZONE SELECT]
[POWER OFF]
Amp Assign / Multi-zone Connections and
Operations
Connections
The sub remote control unit (RC-1071) included with the AVR-2808 can be used as the exclusive multizone remote control unit.
bThe following describes operation for the selected zone. (Use [ZONE SELECT] to switch zones.)
•Turning the multi-zone power on and off
•Selecting the input source to be played
•Adjusting and temporarily muting the multi-zone volume
•Listening to the tuner
Getting Started
Sub Remote Control Unit
bWhen using a Control Dock for iPod (ASD-1R), [FAVORITES DIRECT PLAY] cannot be used.
57
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
61
2007/09/28
11:41:52
ENGLISH
Getting Started
Setting 1 :
F7.1-channel
Setting 3 :
playback
FMulti-zone playback
•5.1-channel playback + ZONE2 or ZONE3 stereo playback
•5.1-channel playback + ZONE2 + ZONE3 monaural playback
Main zone
FL SW
C
FR
Connections
Main zone
FL SW
Amp Assign mode:
7.1ch
SL
SR
C
+
7.1ch (Default)
Setup
5.1ch
SL
SBL
ZONE3
ZONE2
FR
SR
SBR
+
Playback
+
Z2L
Z2R
+
Stereo
Z2L
Z2R
+
Z2
+
Mono
Z3L
Amp Assign mode:
Z3R
ZONE2
Z3L
Z3R
ZONE3
Stereo
Z3
ZONE2/3-MONO
Mono
Remote Control
nAmp Assign mode setting and speakers connected to the various speaker
terminals
Speaker terminal
Amp Assign mode
7.1ch
FRONT
R
L
FR
FL
SURR. BACK /
AMP ASSIGN
SURR
CENTER
C
R
L
R
L
SR
SL
SBR
SBL
Multi-Zone
Setting 2 : With this setting it is possible to switch between the following two playback modes.
Information
F5.1-channel playback
2-channel
Switching·················Surround Mode switching
playback
Main zone
FL
L
C
R
FL
Troubleshooting
Surround Mode
SW
5.1ch
SL
L
Multi Channel /
Surround
R
FR
Speaker terminal
SL
Amp Assign mode:
2ch
FRONT
R
L
ZONE2
Z2R
Z2L
ZONE3
Z3R
Z3L
FR
L
SURR. BACK /
AMP ASSIGN
SURR
CENTER
R
ZONE2/3-MONO
SW
DIRECT / STEREO
SR
C
nAmp Assign mode setting and speakers connected to the various speaker
terminals
Amp Assign mode
Main zone
FR
“STEREO” or “MONO” depends on the setting at menu “Manual Setup” – “(select the zone)” – “Zone
Setup” – “Channel” (vpage 30).
FL
R
C
SR
L
SL
Z3
Z2
(MONO) (MONO)
2ch
SR
nAmp Assign mode setting and speakers connected to the various speaker
terminals
Speaker terminal
Amp Assign mode
2ch
FRONT
R
L
FR
FL
C
SURR. BACK /
AMP ASSIGN
SURR
CENTER
R
L
R
L
SR
SL
FR
FL
58
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
62
2007/09/28
11:41:53
ENGLISH
FMaking
bi-amp connections for the FL and FR channels in the main zone
and conducting 5.1-channel playback
(switching with other modes not possible)
FL SW
5.1ch
FL/FR
Bi-Amp
FR
Connectors for audio output
Audio signals
Connectors for video output
ZONE2
ZONE2 PRE OUT
Stereo
ZONE2 VIDEO OUT
ZONE3
ZONE3 PRE OUT
Stereo
–
Amp Assign mode:
SR
Front A Bi-Amp
Main zone (7.1-channel system)
ZONE2
Monitor
Front B Bi-Amp
Monitor
48
'3
Power amplifier
$
Speaker terminal
FRONT-B
R
R
L
CENTER
L
SURR
R
L
Front A Bi-Amp
Front B Bi-Amp
FL-A
FR-B
FL-B
C
SR
SL
Input
ZONE2
audio output
SURR. BACK / AMP
ASSIGN
R
L
FR
FL
FL-A/FR-A Bi-Amp
connection
FR
FL
FL-B/FR-B Bi-Amp
connection
43
4-
Remote
control unit
4#
-
4#
3
ZONE3
Power amplifier
ZONE3 audio output
Information
FR-A
AVR-2808
DVD player
Multi-Zone
Amp Assign mode
FRONT-A
ZONE2
video output
Remote Control
nAmp Assign mode setting and speakers connected to the various speaker
terminals
Playback
'-
Setup
SL
C
Prepare power amplifiers for ZONE2 and ZONE3.
Connections
Main zone
Multi-zone
and Operations with Zone Pre-out
controlSettings
unit
Output
Getting Started
Remote
Setting 4 :
: Multi-zone video cable
: Multi-zone audio cable
Troubleshooting
•When only using one speaker for ZONE2 or ZONE3, set to “Mono”. In this case, the ZONE2 (ZONE3)
monaural output is output from the ZONE2 (ZONE3) pre-out L and R connectors, so connect as desired.
•Separate power amplifiers are needed for ZONE2 and ZONE3.
59
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
63
2007/09/28
11:41:54
ENGLISH
Getting Started
SOURCE SELECT <ZONE3 ON/OFF>
VOLUME
Multi-zone Operations
Turning the Power On and Off
Connections
GOperation on the main unitH
Press <ZONE2 ON/OFF> or <ZONE3 ON/OFF> for the zone to be operated.
When the power turns on, the multi-zone indicator (
or
)
lights on the display.
GOperation on the remote control unitH
Setup
In the zone mode you want to operate, press [ON] or [OFF].
Playback
<ZONE2 ON/OFF>
<ZONE2/3 / REC SELECT>
Selecting the Input Source
GOperation on the main unitH
Remote Control
[
q Press <ZONE2/3 / REC SELECT> and select the zone to be adjusted.
w Turn <SOURCE SELECT>.
AMP]
GOperation on the remote control unitH
In the zone mode you want to operate, press [SOURCE SELECT].
[ON]
[OFF]
[ON]
[OFF]
Multi-Zone
VOLUME
Information
(ZONE2
mode)
SOURCE
SELECT
(ZONE3
mode)
[MUTE]
Turning off the Sound Temporarily
In the zone mode for which you want to mute the sound, press
[MUTE].
The sound is reduced to the level set at menu “Manual Setup” – “Zone
Setup” – “(select the zone)” – “Mute Level” (vpage 30).
To cancel, either adjust the volume or press [MUTE] again.
The setting is canceled when the zone’s power is turned off.
The source selected for ZONE2 is also output from the recording
output connectors.
NOTE
•When the input source to which the digital input connectors
(OPTICAL/COAXIAL) are assigned is selected in ZONE2 or ZONE3,
playback is only possible if the digital signal being input is in PCM
(2-channel) format.
•Digital audio signals input from the HDMI connectors cannot be
played in multi-zone.
•When certain digital signals are being input, noise may be output
from the ZONE2 and ZONE3 audio output connectors.
Adjusting the Volume
GOperation on the main unitH
q Press <ZONE2/3 / REC SELECT> and select the zone to be adjusted.
w Turn <VOLUME> to adjust.
GOperation on the remote control unitH
In the zone mode whose volume you want to adjust, press [VOLUME].
[Variable range]
–––
–70dB ~ –40dB ~ +18dB
Troubleshooting
(Main remote control unit)
[OFF]
[ON]
SOURCE SELECT
The volume can be adjusted when menu “Manual Setup” – “Zone
Setup” – “(select the zone)” – “Volume Level” is set to “VAR”. The
volume can be increased up to the value set at menu “Manual Setup”
– “Zone Setup” – “(select the zone)” – “Volume Limit” (vpage 30).
[MUTE]
(Sub remote control unit)
About the button names in these explanations
< > : Buttons on the main unit
[
] : Buttons on the remote control unit
Button name only:
Buttons on the main unit and remote control unit
60
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
64
2007/09/28
11:41:55
ENGLISH
We recommend installing the speakers for the surround “L” and “R”
channels a bit forward.
Path of the surround sound from the
speakers to the listening position
We recommend using 2 speakers.
When using dipolar speakers in particular, be sure to use 2 speakers.
Other Information
About Speaker Installation
Surround back speakers
48
$
'3
Below we introduce examples of speaker layouts. Refer to these to
arrange your speakers according to their type and how you want to
use them.
60 to 90 cm
qWhen mainly playing movies
Recommended when your surround speakers are single or 2-way
speakers.
'3
Monitor
Subwoofer
Front speaker
60 to 90 cm
Point slightly
downwards
60°
45° ~ 60°
Surround
speaker
4-DI
Surround back
speaker
Front speaker
60 to 90 cm
Surround back speakers
GAs seen from aboveH
Surround
speaker
GAs seen from the sideH
Point slightly
downwards
Troubleshooting
$
Surround back
speaker
Information
48
Multi-Zone
'-
GAs seen from the sideH
Front speakers
Center speaker
Surround
speaker
Movement of acoustic image from SR to SL
Change of positioning and acoustic image
with 6.1-channel systems
Surround back speakers
eWhen playing movies and music
60°
Surround
speakers
Point slightly
downwards
60°
GAs seen from aboveH
Monitor
Subwoofer
43DI
Surround back
speaker
Front speaker
G1H Using surround back speaker(s)
Front speakers
Center speaker
4-DI
Surround
speaker
Surround
speakers
Remote Control
'-
Examples of speaker layouts
Playback
Change of positioning and acoustic image
with 5.1-channel systems
Setup
Sound positioning directly to the rear can be achieved easily by adding
a surround back speaker to a 5.1-channel system.
In addition, the acoustic image extending between the sides and the
rear is narrowed, thus greatly improving the expression of the surround
signals for sounds moving from the sides to the back and from the
front to the point directly behind the listening position.
Connections
Placement of the surround left and right channels
when using surround back speakers
wSetting for primarily watching movies using diffusion type
speakers for the surround speakers
For the greatest sense of surround sound envelopment, diffuse
radiation speakers such as bipolar types, or dipolar types, provide
a wider dispersion than is possible to obtain from a direct radiating
speaker (monopolar). Place these speakers at either side of the
prime listening position, mounted above ear level.
Getting Started
Number of surround back speakers
43DI
Surround back
speaker
seen
from aboveH
GAs
GAs seen from the sideH
4#DI
Movement of acoustic image from
SR to SB to SL
In addition to sources recorded in 6.1-channels, the surround effect of
conventional 2- to 5.1-channel sources can also be enhanced.
61
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
65
2007/09/28
11:41:56
ENGLISH
Getting Started
G2H When not using surround back speakers
Front speakers
Center speaker
Dolby TrueHD is a high definition audio technology developed by Dolby
Laboratories, using lossless coding technology to faithfully reproduce
the sound of the studio master.
This format is compatible with a maximum sampling frequency of 96
kHz and up to 7.1-channels, so it is used for applications particularly
prioritizing sound quality.
Connections
Monitor
Subwoofer
60°
Surround speaker
Front speaker
Setup
60 to 90 cm
Playback
120°
Surround speakers
Remote Control
GAs seen from aboveH
Dolby TrueHD
GAs seen from the sideH
Surround
Multi-Zone
The AVR-2808 is equipped with a digital signal processing circuit that
lets you play program sources in the surround mode to achieve the
same sense of presence as in a movie theater.
Dolby Surround
Information
Dolby Digital
Troubleshooting
Dolby Digital is a multichannel digital signal format developed by Dolby
Laboratories.
A total of 5.1-channels are played: 3 front channels (“FL” , “FR” and
“C”), 2 surround channels (“SL” and “SR”) and the “LFE” channel for
low frequencies.
Because of this, there is no crosstalk between channels and a realistic
sound field with a “three-dimensional” feeling (sense of distance,
movement and positioning) is achieved.
A real, overpowering sense of presence is achieved when playing
movie sources in AV rooms as well.
Dolby Digital Plus
Dolby Digital Plus is an improved Dolby Digital signal format that is
compatible with up to 7.1-channels of discrete digital sound and also
improves sound quality thanks to extra data bit rate performance. It
is upwardly compatible with conventional Dolby Digital, so it offers
greater flexibility in response to the source signal and the conditions
of the playback equipment.
DTS Surround
DTS Digital Surround
DTS Digital Surround is the standard digital surround format of DTS,
Inc., compatible with a sampling frequency of 44.1 or 48 kHz and up
to 5.1-channels of digital discrete surround sound.
Dolby Pro Logic g
DTS-HD High Resolution Audio
Dolby Pro Logic g is a matrix decoding technology developed by Dolby
Laboratories.
Regular music such as that on CDs is encoded into 5-channels to
achieve an excellent surround effect.
The surround channel signals are converted into stereo and full band
signals (with a frequency response of 20 Hz to 20 kHz or greater)
to create a “three-dimensional” sound image offering a rich sense of
presence for all stereo sources.
DTS-HD High Resolution Audio is an improved version of the
conventional DTS, DTS-ES and DTS 96/24 signals formats, compatible
with sampling frequencies of 96 or 48 kHz and up to 7.1-channels
of discrete digital sound. High data bit rate performance provides
high quality sound. This format is fully compatible with conventional
products, including conventional DTS digital surround 5.1-channel
data.
Dolby Pro Logic gx
Dolby Pro Logic gx is a further improved version of the Dolby Pro Logic
g matrix decoding technology.
Audio signals recorded in 2-channels are decoded to achieve a natural
sound with up to 7.1-channels.
There are 3 modes: “Music” suited for playing music, “Cinema”
suited for playing movies, and “Game” which is optimized for playing
games.
bSources recorded in Dolby Surround
Sources recorded in Dolby Surround are indicated with the following
logo marks.
Dolby Surround support mark :
Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories.
“Dolby”, “Pro Logic” and the double-D symbol are trademarks of
Dolby Laboratories.
DTS-HD Master Audio
DTS-HD Master Audio is DTS, Inc’s lossless audio format compatible
with up to 96 kHz/7.1-channels. The lossless audio coding technology
faithfully reproduces the sound of the studio master. It is fully
compatible with conventional products, including conventional DTS
digital surround 5.1-channel data.
DTS-ES™ Discrete 6.1
DTS-ES™ Discrete 6.1 is a 6.1-channel discrete digital audio format
adding a surround back (SB) channel to the DTS digital surround sound.
Decoding of conventional 5.1-channel audio signals is also possible
according to the decoder.
DTS-ES™ Matrix 6.1
DTS-ES™ Matrix 6.1 is a 6.1-channel discrete digital audio format
inserting a surround back (SB) channel to the DTS digital surround
sound through matrix encoding. Decoding of conventional 5.1-channel
audio signals is also possible according to the decoder.
DTS NEO:6™ Surround
DTS NEO:6™ is a matrix decoding technology for achieving 6.1channel surround playback with 2-channel sources. It includes “DTS
NEO:6 CINEMA” suited for playing movies and “DTS NEO:6 MUSIC”
suited for playing music.
62
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
66
2007/09/28
11:41:57
ENGLISH
DTS 96/24 is a digital audio format enabling high sound quality
playback in 5.1-channels with a sampling frequency of 96 kHz and 24
bit quantization on DVD-Video.
HDMI
(High-Definition Multimedia Interface)
HDMI is a digital interface standard for next generation TVs based
on DVI (Digital Visual Interface) standards and optimized for use in
consumer equipment.
Non-compressed digital video and multi-channel audio signals are
transmitted with a single connection.
HDMI is also compatible with HDCP (High-bandwidth Digital Contents
Protection), a technology for protecting copyrights that encrypts digital
video signals in the same was as with DVI.
Remote Control
Multi-Zone
Deep Color
Eliminates on-screen color banding, for smooth tonal transitions and
subtle gradations between colors.
Enables increased contrast ratio.
Can represent many times more shades of gray between black and
white.
At 30-bit pixel depth, a four times improvement would be the minimum,
and the typical improvement would be eight times or more.
Information
Troubleshooting
Audyssey MultEQ® XT is a trademark of Audyssey Laboratories.
It is licensed under U.S. and National Patent Applications
20030235318 and 10/700,220. Additional U.S. and Foreign
Patents pending. MultEQ XT and the Audyssey MultEQ XT logo
are trademarks of Audyssey Laboratories, Inc. All rights reserved.
“HDMI”, “HDMI logo” and “High-Definition Multimedia Interface”
are trademarks or registered trademarks of HDMI Licensing
LLC.
Playback
Audyssey MultEQ® XT is the first technology to properly measure
sound information throughout a listening area, then combine this
information to accurately represent the acoustical problems in
the room. Based on these measurements, MultEQ XT calculates
an equalization solution that corrects for both time and frequency
response problems in every seat.
Audyssey MultEQ XT not only corrects frequency response problem
in a large listening area, it also performs a fully automated surround
system setup.
For a detailed description, see page 23.
Because consumer electronics devices are using increasingly
complex digital signal processing to enhance the clarity and detail of
the content, synchronization of video and audio in user devices has
become a greater challenge and could potentially require complex enduser adjustments. HDMI 1.3 incorporates an automatic video/audio
synching capability that allows devices to perform this synchronization
automatically with total accuracy.
Setup
Audyssey MultEQ® XT
AL24 Processing for All Channels
DENON has further developed its proprietary AL24 Processing, an
analog waveform reproduction technology, to support the 192-kHz
sampling frequency of DVD-Audio. AL24 Processing Plus, thoroughly
suppresses quantization noise associated with D/A conversion of
LPCM signals to reproduce the low-level signals with optimum clarity
that will bring out all the delicate nuances of the music.
Equipped foe not only front left and right channels but also for the
surround left and right, center and subwoofer channels.
Lip Sync
Connections
Manufactured under license under U.S. Patent #’s: 5,451,942;
5,956,674; 5,974,380; 5,978,762; 6,226,616; 6,487,535 & other
U.S. and worldwide patents issued & pending. DTS is a registered
trademark and the DTS logos, Symbol, DTS-HD and DTS-HD
Master Audio are trademarks of DTS, Inc.© 1996-2007 DTS, Inc.
All Rights Reserved.
AL24 Processing Plus
Getting Started
DTS 96/24
xvYCC
Next-generation “xvYCC” color space supports 1.8 times as many
colors as existing HDTV signals.
Lets HDTVs display colors more accurately.
Enables displays with natural, vivid colors.
63
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
67
2007/09/28
11:41:57
ENGLISH
Getting Started
Surround Modes and Parameters
Signals and adjustability in the different modes
Channel output
Surround mode
Parameter (default values are shown in parentheses)
Connections
Setup
Playback
Remote Control
Front L/R
Center
Surround L/R
Surround
Back L/R
PURE DIRECT, DIRECT
S
A
A
A
D
S (OFF)
S ( 0 dB)
A
A
DSD DIRECT
S
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
DSD MULTI DIRECT
S
D
D
D
D
A
S ( 0 dB)
A
MULTI CH DIRECT
S
D
D
D
D
A
S ( 0 dB)
STEREO
S
A
A
A
D
S (OFF)
EXT. IN
S
D
D
D
D
MULTI CH IN
S
D
D
D
WIDE SCREEN
S
D
D
DOLBY PRO LOGIC gx
S
D
DOLBY PRO LOGIC g
S
DTS NEO:6
Su­b­­­­woofer
D. COMP
LFE
AFDM
Multi-Zone
Information
MODE
ROOM SIZE
LEVEL
DELAY TIME
Subwoofer
A
A
A
A
A
S
A
A
A
A
A
S
S
A
A
A
A
A
A
S (ON)
S
A
A
A
A
A
A
S ( 0 dB)
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
D
A
S ( 0 dB)
S (ON)
S
A
A
A
A
A
A
D
D
S (OFF)
S ( 0 dB)
A
S
S (OFF)
A
A
S (ON, 10)
A
A
D
D
D
S (OFF)
A
A
S
S (NOTE1) S (CINEMA)
A
A
A
A
D
D
A
D
S (OFF)
A
A
S
S (NOTE2) S (CINEMA)
A
A
A
A
S
D
D
D
D
S (OFF)
A
A
S
S (NOTE1) S (CINEMA)
A
A
A
A
DOLBY DIGITAL
S
D
D
D
D
S (OFF)
S ( 0 dB)
S (ON)
S
S (OFF)
A
A
A
A
A
DTS SURROUND
S
D
D
D
D
S (OFF)
S ( 0 dB)
S (ON)
S
S (OFF)
A
A
A
A
A
7CH STEREO
S
D
D
D
D
S (OFF)
S ( 0 dB)
A
S
A
A
A
A
A
A
SUPER STADIUM
S
D
D
D
D
S (OFF)
S ( 0 dB)
A
S
A
A
S (medium)
S (10)
A
A
ROCK ARENA
S
D
D
D
D
S (OFF)
S ( 0 dB)
A
S
A
A
S (medium)
S (10)
A
A
JAZZ CLUB
S
D
D
D
D
S (OFF)
S ( 0 dB)
A
S
A
A
S (medium)
S (10)
A
A
CLASSIC CONCERT
S
D
D
D
D
S (OFF)
S ( 0 dB)
A
S
A
A
S (medium)
S (10)
A
A
MONO MOVIE
S
D
D
D
D
S (OFF)
S ( 0 dB)
A
S
A
A
S (medium)
S (10)
A
A
VIDEO GAME
S
D
D
D
D
S (OFF)
S ( 0 dB)
A
S
A
A
S (medium)
S (10)
A
A
MATRIX
S
D
D
D
D
S (OFF)
S ( 0 dB)
A
S
A
A
A
A
S (30 ms)
A
VIRTURL
S
A
A
A
D
S (OFF)
S ( 0 dB)
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
Troubleshooting
S: Signal / Adjustable
A : No signal / Not adjustable
D:Turned on or off by speaker configuration setting
z1
z2
z1
SB CH OUT CINEMA EQ.
S: Signal / Adjustable
A : No signal / Not adjustable
NOTE1 :This parameter is availabe when the menu “Parameter” – “Surround Parameter” – “MODE” is set to “CINEMA” (vpage 38).
NOTE2 :This parameter is availabe when the menu “Parameter” – “Surround Parameter” – “MODE” is set to “CINEMA” or “PL” (vpage 38).
NOTE:
z1 :When playing Dolby Digital and DTS signals.
z2 :When playing Dolby Digital, DTS, DVD-Audio and Super Audio CD.
64
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
68
2007/09/28
11:41:58
ENGLISH
Getting Started
Signals and adjustability in the different modes
Parameter (default values are shown in parentheses)
Surround mode
PRO LOGIC g/gx MUSIC mode only
NEO:6 MUSIC
mode only
EXT. IN only
S (OFF)
S (NOTE5)
S
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
S (OFF)
S (NOTE5)
A
A
A
A
A
S (0 dB)
S (OFF)
S (OFF)
S
A
A
A
A
S
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
S (0 dB)
S (OFF)
S (OFF)
A
A
A
A
A
A
S (0 dB)
S (OFF)
S (OFF)
S
DOLBY PRO LOGIC gx
S (OFF)
S (3)
S (3)
A
A
S (0 dB)
S (OFF)
S (OFF)
S
DOLBY PRO LOGIC g
S (OFF)
S (3)
S (3)
A
A
S (0 dB)
S (OFF)
S (OFF)
S
DTS NEO:6
A
A
A
S (0.3)
A
S (0 dB)
S (OFF)
S (OFF)
S
DOLBY DIGITAL
A
A
A
A
A
S (0 dB)
S (OFF)
S (OFF)
A
DTS SURROUND
A
A
A
A
A
S (0 dB)
S (OFF)
S (OFF)
A
7CH STEREO
A
A
A
A
A
S (0 dB)
S (OFF)
S (OFF)
S
SUPER STADIUM
A
A
A
A
A
S (NOTE3)
S (OFF)
S (OFF)
S
ROCK ARENA
A
A
A
A
A
S (NOTE4)
S (OFF)
S (OFF)
S
JAZZ CLUB
A
A
A
A
A
S (0 dB)
S (OFF)
S (OFF)
S
CLASSIC CONCERT
A
A
A
A
A
S (0 dB)
S (OFF)
S (OFF)
S
MONO MOVIE
A
A
A
A
A
S (0 dB)
S (OFF)
S (OFF)
S
VIDEO GAME
A
A
A
A
A
S (0 dB)
S (OFF)
S (OFF)
S
MATRIX
A
A
A
A
A
S (0 dB)
S (OFF)
S (OFF)
S
VIRTURL
A
A
A
A
A
S (0 dB)
S (OFF)
S (OFF)
S
A
A
A
A
DSD DIRECT
A
A
A
A
DSD MULTI DIRECT
A
A
A
MULTI CH DIRECT
A
A
STEREO
A
EXT. IN
MULTI CH IN
WIDE SCREEN
Information
A
A
PURE DIRECT, DIRECT
Multi-Zone
A
SW ATT
Remote Control
RESTORER
CENTER
IMAGE
Playback
Room EQ
CENTER
WIDTH
Setup
Night Mode
DIMENSION
Connections
Tone Control
PANORAMA
Troubleshooting
S: Adjustable
A : Not adjustable
NOTE3 :BASS +6 dB, TREBLE 0 dB
NOTE4 :BASS +6 dB, TREBLE +4 dB
NOTE5 : Can be used according to the “Direct Mode Setup” setting.
65
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
69
2007/09/28
11:41:59
ENGLISH
Getting Started
Differences in Surround Mode Names Depending on the Input Signals
Input signals
Button
DTS
Surround mode
Note
Connections
ANALOG
LINEAR
PCM
DTS ES
DSCRT
(With Flag)
DOLBY DIGITAL
DTS ES
MTRX
(With Flag)
DTS
(5.1ch)
DTS
96/24
DOLBY
DIGITAL EX
(With Flag)
DOLBY
DIGITAL EX
(With no
Flag)
DVD-AUDIO
DOLBY
DIGITAL
(5.1/5/4ch)
DOLBY
DIGITAL
(4/3ch)
DOLBY
DVD-Audio
DIGITAL
(multi ch)
(2ch)
Super Audio CD
DVDAudio
(2ch)
DSD
(multi ch)
DSD
(2ch)
STANDARD
DTS SURROUND
Setup
A
A
F D
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
DTS ES MTRX6.1
z1
A
A
A
F D
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
DTS SURROUND
A
A
S
S
F
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
F
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
DTS 96/24
DTS + PLgx CINEMA
z2
A
A
S
S
S
S
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
DTS + PLgx MUSIC
z1
A
A
S
S
S
S
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
Remote Control
z1
Playback
DTS ES DSCRT6.1
DTS + NEO:6
z1
A
A
A
S
S
S
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
DTS NEO:6 CINEMA
S
S
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
S
A
S
A
S
DTS NEO:6 MUSIC
S
S
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
S
A
S
A
S
A
A
A
A
A
A
S
S
S
S
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
S
F
F
F
A
A
A
A
A
A
DOLBY SURROUND
DOLBY DIGITAL EX
z1
DOLBY DIGITAL
Multi-Zone
DOLBY DIGITAL + PLgx CINEMA
z2
A
A
A
A
A
A
F D
S
S
S
A
A
A
A
DOLBY DIGITAL + PLgx MUSIC
z1
A
A
A
A
A
A
S
S
S
S
A
A
A
A
A
DOLBY PRO LOGIC gx CINEMA
S
S
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
F
A
S
A
S
DOLBY PRO LOGIC gx MUSIC
S
S
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
S
A
S
A
S
Information
DOLBY PRO LOGIC gx GAME
S
S
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
S
A
S
A
S
DOLBY PRO LOGIC g CINEMA
S
S
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
S
A
S
A
S
DOLBY PRO LOGIC g MUSIC
S
S
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
S
A
S
A
S
DOLBY PRO LOGIC g GAME
S
S
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
S
A
S
A
S
Troubleshooting
DOLBY PRO LOGIC
S
S
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
S
A
S
A
S
MULTI CH IN
MULTI CH IN
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
F
A
F
A
MULTI IN + PLgx CINEMA
z2
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
S
A
S
A
MULTI IN + PLgx MUSIC
z1
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
S
A
S
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
F D (7.1)
A
A
A
MULTI CH IN 7.1
NOTE:
z1: This mode is not available when the surround back speaker setup is set to “None”
.
z2: This mode is not available when the surround back speaker setup is set to “1spkr” or “None”
.
F : Mode selectable in initial status
D : Mode fixed when “AFDM” is “ON”
S : Selectable mode
A : Non-selectable mode
66
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
70
2007/09/28
11:42:00
ENGLISH
DTS
Note
DOLBY DIGITAL
Super Audio CD
DTS
96/24
DOLBY
DIGITAL EX
(With no
Flag)
DOLBY
DIGITAL
(5.1/5/4ch)
DOLBY
DIGITAL
(4/3ch)
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
A
S
A
S
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
S
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
S
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
S
A
S
A
ANALOG
DTS ES
DSCRT
(With Flag)
DTS ES
MTRX
(With Flag)
DTS
(5.1ch)
DIRECT
S
S
S
S
DSD DIRECT
A
A
A
A
DSD MULTI DIRECT
A
A
A
MULTI CH DIRECT
A
A
Surround mode
DVD-AUDIO
DOLBY
DIGITAL EX
(With Flag)
LINEAR
PCM
DOLBY
DVDDIGITAL
Audio
(2ch)
(multi ch)
DVDAudio
(2ch)
DSD
DSD (2ch)
(multi ch)
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
S
A
S
A
M DIRECT + PLgx MUSIC
z1
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
S
A
S
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
S
A
A
A
PURE DIRECT
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
A
S
A
S
DSD PURE DIRECT
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
S
DSD MULTI PURE
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
S
A
MULTI CH PURE DIRECT
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
S
A
S
A
M DIRECT 7.1
Playback
z2
Setup
M DIRECT + PLgx CINEMA
Connections
DIRECT
PURE DIRECT
z2
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
S
A
S
A
M PURE D + PLgx MUSIC
z1
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
S
A
S
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
S
A
A
A
Multi-Zone
M CH PURE DIRECT 7.1
Remote Control
M PURE D + PLgx CINEMA
DSP SIMULATION
7CH STEREO
z3
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
SUPER STADIUM
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
ROCK ARENA
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
JAZZ CLUB
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
CLASSIC CONCERT
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
MONO MOVIE
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
VIDEO GAME
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
MATRIX
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
VIRTUAL
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
F
F
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
F
S
F
Troubleshooting
S
S
Information
S
WIDE SCREEN
STEREO
STEREO
Getting Started
Input signals
Button
NOTE :
z1: This mode is not available when the surround back speaker setup is set to “None”
.
z2: This mode is not available when the surround back speaker setup is set to “1spkr” or “None”
.
z3: If the surround back speaker setup is set to “None”
, then “5CH STEREO” is displayed.
F : Mode selectable in initial status
S : Selectable mode
A : Non-selectable mode
67
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
71
2007/09/28
11:42:01
ENGLISH
Getting Started
Relationship Between Video Signals and Monitor Output
Video convert
Connections
Setup
Playback
ON
Remote Control
Multi-Zone
HDMI
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
Input signals
COMPONENT
A
A
A
A
S (1080p)
S (480p ~ 720p)
S (480i / 576i)
S (1080p)
S (480p ~ 720p)
S (480i / 576i)
S (1080p)
S (480p ~ 720p)
S (480i / 576i)
S (1080p)
S (480p ~ 720p)
S (480i / 576i)
A
A
A
A
S (Other than 480i / 576i)
S (480i / 576i)
S (1080p)
S (480p ~ 720p)
S (480i / 576i)
S (Other than 480i / 576i)
S (480i / 576i)
S (Other than 480i / 576i)
S (480i / 576i)
Information
S: Signal input
A : No signal
480p ~ 720p: 480p / 576p / 1080i / 720p
S-VIDEO
A
A
S
S
A
A
A
A
A
A
S
S
S
S
S
S
A
A
S
S
A
A
A
A
A
S
S
S
S
VIDEO
A
S
A
S
A
A
A
S
S
S
A
A
A
S
S
S
A
S
A
S
A
A
S
S
S
A
A
S
S
HDMI
A
VIDEO
S-VIDEO
S-VIDEO
A
COMPONENT
COMPONENT
VIDEO
COMPONENTz1
COMPONENTz1
S-VIDEO
COMPONENTz2
COMPONENTz2
S-VIDEO
COMPONENTz2
COMPONENTz2
HDMI
HDMIz1
HDMIz2
HDMIz2
HDMI
HDMI
HDMIz1
HDMIz1
HDMIz1
HDMIz2
HDMIz2
HDMIz2
HDMIz2
MONITOR OUT
COMPONENT
S-VIDEO
A
A
VIDEO
VIDEO
S-VIDEO
S-VIDEO
S-VIDEO
S-VIDEO
COMPONENT
A
COMPONENT
A
COMPONENT
COMPONENT
z
COMPONENT 1
VIDEO
COMPONENTz1
A
z
COMPONENT 1
COMPONENT
z
COMPONENT 2
S-VIDEO
COMPONENTz2
S-VIDEO
z
COMPONENT 2
S-VIDEO
z
COMPONENT 2
S-VIDEO
z
COMPONENT 2
S-VIDEO
z
COMPONENT 2
S-VIDEO
A
A
VIDEO
VIDEO
S-VIDEO
S-VIDEO
S-VIDEO
S-VIDEO
COMPONENT
A
COMPONENT
COMPONENT
z
COMPONENT 1
VIDEO
COMPONENTz1
A
COMPONENTz1
COMPONENT
COMPONENTz2
S-VIDEO
COMPONENTz2
S-VIDEO
COMPONENTz2
S-VIDEO
COMPONENTz2
S-VIDEO
VIDEO
A
VIDEO
S-VIDEO
S-VIDEO
A
A
COMPONENT
VIDEO
VIDEO
VIDEO
S-VIDEO
S-VIDEO
S-VIDEO
S-VIDEO
S-VIDEO
S-VIDEO
A
VIDEO
S-VIDEO
S-VIDEO
A
COMPONENT
VIDEO
VIDEO
VIDEO
S-VIDEO
S-VIDEO
S-VIDEO
S-VIDEO
A : Not output
z1: On-screen display superimposed on video signal and output.
z2: On-screen display superimposed on S-Video signal and output.
Troubleshooting
COMPONENT or HDMI :
On-screen display only displayed for MENU button and the main remote
control unit’s PARA button.
• The main zone video conversion function is compatible with the following format: NTSC, PAL, SECAM, NTSC4.43, PAL-N, PAL-M and PAL-60.
• When SECAM signals of video input are up-converted, the signals are output in PAL format from the S-Video connector.
• When the input signal is a component 1080i or 720p signal, the signal upconverted to HDMI is output with that resolution or 1080p.
• When the input signal is a video, S-Video or component 480i, 480p, 576i or 576p signals, the signal up-converted to HDMI is output according to
the setting made at “Resolution” under “HDMI Setup” – “HDMI Video Setup” (vpage 28).
68
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
72
2007/09/28
11:42:02
ENGLISH
MONITOR OUT
HDMI
COMPONENT
S-VIDEO
VIDEO
A
A
A
A
VIDEO
A
A
A
S-VIDEO
A
A
A
S-VIDEO
VIDEOz2
A
A
—
VIDEO
A
A
COMPONENT
A
A
A
z
COMPONENT 1
VIDEO
A
A
z
COMPONENT 2
S-VIDEO
A
A
COMPONENTz2
S-VIDEO
VIDEOz2
A
z
COMPONENT 1
—
VIDEO
A
HDMI
A
A
A
HDMI
VIDEO
A
A
HDMI
S-VIDEO
A
A
HDMI
S-VIDEO
VIDEOz2
A
HDMI
—
VIDEO
A
HDMI
COMPONENT
A
A
z
HDMI
COMPONENT 1
VIDEO
A
z
HDMI
COMPONENT 2
S-VIDEO
A
HDMI
COMPONENTz2
S-VIDEO
VIDEOz2
z
HDMI
COMPONENT 1
—
VIDEO
A : Not output
z1: On-screen display superimposed on video signal and output.
z2: On-screen display superimposed on S-Video signal and output.
Playback
Remote Control
VIDEO
A
S
A
S
S
A
S
A
S
S
A
S
A
S
S
A
S
A
S
S
Setup
Input signals
HDMI
COMPONENT S-VIDEO
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
S
A
A
S
A
A
S
A
S
A
A
S
A
A
S
S
A
S
S
A
S
S
S
A
A
S
A
A
S
A
S
S
A
S
S
A
S
S
S
A
S
S
A
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S: Signal input
A : No signal
Connections
OFF
S-VIDEO
MONITOR OUT
—
—
—
Used
Not used
—
—
—
Used
Not used
—
—
—
Used
Not used
—
—
—
Used
Not used
Getting Started
Video convert
COMPONENT or HDMI:
On-screen display only displayed for MENU button and the main remote
control unit’s PARA button.
Multi-Zone
nZONE2 monitor out
Input
VIDEO
A
A
A
S
S (VIDEO)
S
A
S (S-VIDEO)
S
S
VIDEO
A
Troubleshooting
S: Signal present
A: No signal
Information
Monitor out
S-VIDEO
S (S-VIDEO)
S : Output present
A : No output
69
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
73
2007/09/28
11:42:03
ENGLISH
Getting Started
Symptom
Power turns off
suddenly and
power indicator
flashes red.
Troubleshooting
Connections
Setup
If a problem should arise, first check the following:
1. Are the connections correct?
2. Is the set being operated as described in the owner’s manual?
3. Are the other components operating properly?
If this unit does not operate properly, check the items listed in the table below. Should the problem persist,
there may be a malfunction.
In this case, disconnect the power immediately and contact your store of purchase.
Playback
GGeneralH
Remote Control
Symptom
Power does not
turn on, or turns
off directly after it
was turned on.
No sound is
produced from
speakers.
Multi-Zone
Information
Troubleshooting
Cause
Countermeasure
•Connection of the power cord is •Check that the power plugs are
faulty.
securely inserted into the AVR2808’s AC inlet and the wall
power outlet.
•Connection with the input •Check the connections.
devices or connection of the
speaker cables is faulty.
•Device you want to play and set •Select an appropriate input
input source do not match.
source.
•Master volume is turned too •Adjust the master volume to an
low.
appropriate level.
•Mute mode is set.
•Cancel the mute mode.
•Headphones are connected.
•Disconnect the headphones.
•No digital signals are being •Select an input source for which
input.
the digital input setting has been
made.
•The connectors to which the •Set the input mode.
digital inputs are assigned and
the settable input modes do not
match.
Display is off.
•The “Dimmer” setting is set to •Set to something other than
“OFF”.
“OFF”.
•The PURE DIRECT mode is set. •Set a surround mode other than
the PURE DIRECT mode.
“DOLBY DIGITAL” •DVD player’s digital audio output •Check the DVD player’s audio
indicator does not
setting is not proper.
output setting. For details, read
appear on display.
the DVD player’s operating
instructions.
Page
20
Cause
Countermeasure
•Protection circuit activated due •Turn off the power, wait for the
to rise of internal temperature.
set to fully cool down, then turn
the power back on.
•Place the set in a well-ventilated
place.
•Core wires of two speakers are •First unplug the power cord,
touching each other or a core then twist the core wires tightly
wire is sticking out of the terminal or terminate the speaker cables,
and touching the set’s rear panel, then reconnect.
activating the protection circuit.
•Speakers with an impedance •Use speakers with the specified
other than specified are being impedance.
used.
•Set is damaged.
•Turn off the power and contact a
DENON service center.
Page
10
10
10
10
–
GRemote Control UnitH
9
43
43
43
43
35
34
Symptom
Cause
Set does not work •Batteries are worn.
properly when
•You are operating outside of the
remote control
specified range.
unit operated.
•Obstacle between main unit and
remote control unit.
•The batteries are not inserted in
the proper direction, as indicated
by the polarity marks in the
battery compartment.
•The set’s remote control sensor
is exposed to strong light (direct
sunlight, inverter type fluorescent
bulb light, etc.).
•The remote ID of the main unit
and remote control unit do not
match.
Countermeasure
•Replace with new batteries.
•Operate within the specified
range.
•Remove the obstacle.
Page
3
3
•Insert the batteries in the
proper direction, following the
polarity marks in the battery
compartment.
•Move the set to a place in which
the remote control sensor will
not be exposed to strong light.
3
•Set the same remote IDs for the
main unit and remote control
unit.
32, 54
3
3
32
38
–
70
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
74
2007/09/28
11:42:03
ENGLISH
36 ~ 38
Cause
Countermeasure
•The “Manual Setup” – “HDMI • Set to “TV”.
Setup” – “HDMI Audio Setup”
– “HDMI Audio Out” setting is
set to “AMP”.
Page
27
GVideoH
31
•Set to something other than
“None”.
•Select a surround playback
mode.
•Turn on the subwoofer’s power.
26
Symptom
No picture
appears.
36 ~ 38
–
26
•Check the connections.
9
•Adjust the subwoofer’s volume
to an appropriate level.
•Set to the STANDARD mode.
49
37
34
DVDs cannot be
copied on a VCR.
38
–
•The connections to the HDMI
connectors are faulty.
•HDMI input setting is improper.
•The monitor is not compatible
with
copyright
protection
(HDCP).
•The HDMI format of the player
and monitor do not match.
•Input source does not match
recorder’s video connection
connector (video or S-Video).
•Check the connections.
11
•Check the HDMI input setting.
•Connect a monitor that is
compatible
with
copyright
protection (HDCP).
•Match the HDMI format of the
player and monitor.
•The video conversion function
does not work for the REC
OUT connectors. Match the
input source and recorder
connections.
•This is not a malfunction. Most
movie software includes copy
prevention signals and cannot be
copied.
35
11
Countermeasure
Page
–
27
–
11
15
Troubleshooting
–
Picture cannot be
recorded.
•Cancel the PURE DIRECT mode.
•High definition (1080i/720p) and
progressive (480p/576p) video
signals are not down-converted.
Set the player to interlace
(480i/576i) signals.
•Set properly.
Page
11 ~ 20
Information
–
No picture
appears
with HDMI
connections.
Countermeasure
•Check the connections.
Multi-Zone
•Set to “Yes”.
Cause
•The connections between the
AVR-2808 and monitor are
faulty.
•The monitor’s input setting is
wrong.
•PURE DIRECT mode is set.
•The player is connected using the
component input connectors, the
monitor is connected using the
video (yellow) or S-Video output
connectors.
Remote Control
•Check the setting and change it
as necessary.
No test tones are
produced when
main remote
control unit’s TEST
TONE button is
pressed.
DTS sound is not •DVD player’s audio output setting •Set the DVD player. For details,
output.
is not set to bitstream.
refer to the DVD player’s
operating instructions.
•DVD player is not compatible •Use a DTS-compatible player.
with DTS sound playback.
•The AVR-2808’s “Decode Mode” •Set to the “Auto” or “DTS”
setting is set to “PCM”.
mode.
HDMI audio
•The “Manual Setup” – “HDMI •Set to “AMP”.
signals are not
Setup” – “HDMI Audio Setup”
output from
– “HDMI Audio Out” setting is
speakers.
set to “TV”.
Symptom
No sound is
output from
the monitor
connected
with HDMI
connections.
Playback
•The surround back speaker’s
power amplifier is assigned to a
different channel.
•Surround back speaker setting is
set to “None”.
•Surround mode not set to a mode
for 6.1- or 7.1-channel playback.
•Subwoofer’s power not turned
on.
•The “Subwoofer” setting at
“Speaker Configuration” is set to
“No”.
•The subwoofer is not properly
connected.
•The subwoofer’s volume is
turned off.
•Surround mode not set to
“STANDARD”.
Page
37
Setup
No sound is
produced from
subwoofer.
Cause
Countermeasure
•You are playing a monaural •The mode is set to something
source (TV, AM radio broadcast, other than “STANDARD”.
etc.) in the STANDARD mode.
•The surround mode is set to •Set to a surround playback
“STEREO”, “DIRECT” or “PURE mode.
DIRECT”.
Connections
Symptom
No sound is
produced from
center speaker.
No sound
is produced
from surround
speakers.
No sound is
produced from
surround back
speaker.
Getting Started
GAudioH
–
GiPodH
Symptom
iPod cannot be
played.
Cause
•The input source assigned to •Switch to the input source
“iPod dock” is not selected.
assigned at “iPod dock”.
•Cable is not properly connected. •Reconnect.
•Control Dock for iPod’s AC •Plug the Control Dock for iPod’s
adapter is not connected to AC adapter into a power outlet.
power outlet.
35
14
–
71
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
75
2007/09/28
11:42:03
ENGLISH
Getting Started
Specifications
Connections
Setup
Playback
Remote Control
Multi-Zone
Information
Troubleshooting
nAudio section
nVideo section
• Power amplifier
Front (A, B):
Rated output:
110 W + 110 W (8 Ω/ohms, 20 Hz ~ 20 kHz with 0.05 % T.H.D.)
140 W + 140 W (6 Ω/ohms, 1 kHz with 0.7 % T.H.D.)
Center:
110 W (8 Ω/ohms, 20 Hz ~ 20 kHz with 0.05 % T.H.D.)
140 W (6 Ω/ohms, 1 kHz with 0.7 % T.H.D.)
Surround :
110 W + 110 W (8 Ω/ohms, 20 Hz ~ 20 kHz with 0.05 % T.H.D.)
140 W + 140 W (6 Ω/ohms, 1 kHz with 0.7 % T.H.D.)
Surround Back:
110 W + 110 W (8 Ω/ohms, 20 Hz ~ 20 kHz with 0.05 % T.H.D.)
140 W + 140 W (6 Ω/ohms, 1 kHz with 0.7 % T.H.D.)
120 W x 2ch (8 Ω/ohms)
Dynamic power:
170 W x 2ch (4 Ω/ohms)
Output terminals:
Front:
A or B 6 ~ 16 Ω/ohms
A + B 8 ~ 16 Ω/ohms
Center, Surround, Surr. Back: 6 ~ 16 Ω/ohms
• Analog
Input sensitivity / Input impedance: 200 mV / 47 kΩ/kohms
10 Hz ~ 100 kHz +1, -3 dB (DIRECT mode)
Frequency response:
102 dB (DIRECT mode)
S/N:
0.005 % (20 Hz ~ 20 kHz) (DIRECT mode)
Distortion:
1.2 V
Rated output:
• Digital
Rated output — 2 V (at 0 dB playback)
D/A output:
Total harmonic distortion — 0.008 % (1 kHz, at 0 dB)
S /N ratio — 102 dB
Dynamic range — 96 dB
Format — Digital audio interface
Digital input:
• Phono equalizer (PHONO input — REC OUT)
2.5 mV
Input sensitivity:
±1 dB (20 Hz to 20 kHz)
RIAA deviation:
74 dB (A weighting, with 5 mV input)
S/N:
150 mV
Rated output:
0.03 % (1 kHz, 3 V)
Distortion factor:
• Standard video connectors
Input / output level and impedance:
Frequency response:
• S-Video connectors
Input / output level and impedance:
Frequency response:
• Color component video connector
Input / output level and impedance:
Frequency response:
nTuner section
Receiving Range:
Usable Sensitivity:
50 dB Quieting Sensitivity:
S/N (IHF-A):
Total harmonic Distortion (at 1 kHz):
1 Vp-p, 75 Ω/ohms
5 Hz ~ 10 MHz — +0, –3 dB (when video convert set to “OFF”)
Y (brightness) signal — 1 Vp-p, 75 Ω/ohms
C (color) signal — 0.3 (PAL) / 0.286 (NTSC) Vp-p, 75 Ω/ohms
5 Hz ~ 10 MHz — +0, –3 dB (when video convert set to “OFF”)
Y (brightness) signal — 1 Vp-p, 75 Ω/ohms
PB / CB signal — 0.7 Vp-p, 75 Ω/ohms
PR / CR signal — 0.7 Vp-p, 75 Ω/ohms
5 Hz ~ 100 MHz — +0, –3 dB (when video convert set to “OFF”)
[FM]
(note: µV at 75 Ω/ohms, 0 dBf = 1 x 10-15 W)
87.5 MHz ~ 108.0 MHz
1.0 µV (11.2 dBf)
MONO 1.6 µV (15.3 dBf)
STEREO 23 µV (38.5 dBf)
MONO 77 dB
STEREO 72 dB
MONO 0.15 %
STEREO 0.3 %
[AM]
522 kHz ~ 1611 kHz
18 µV
nGeneral
Power supply:
Power consumption:
Maximum external dimensions:
Weight:
AC 230 V, 50 Hz
500 W
0.3 W (Standby)
434 (W) x 171 (H) x 420 (D) mm
13.1 kg
nMain remote control unit (RC-1068)
Batteries:
Maximum external dimensions:
Weight:
LR6/AA Type (two batteries)
63 (W) x 238 (H) x 31 (D) mm
190 g (including batteries)
nSub remote control unit (RC-1071)
Batteries:
Maximum external dimensions:
Weight:
R03/AAA Type (two batteries)
54 (W) x 115 (H) x 23 (D) mm
80 g (including batteries)
z For purposes of improvement, specifications and design are subject to change without notice.
72
1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd
76
2007/09/28
11:42:04
List of preset codes / Liste von voreingestellten Codes / Liste de codes préréglés / Lista dei codici pre-regolati /
Lista de códigos pre-ajustados / Lijst van vooringestelde codes / Förteckning över förinställda koder
Denon Amp
D
Denon
81001, 82001, 83001, 84001
Denon Tuner
D
H
Denon (Analog)
52863, 52795, 52800, 52805
Denon iPod
D
Denon
72815, 72816, 72817, 72818
Cable
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
A-Mark
ABC
Accuphase
Acorn
Action
Active
ADB
Aichi Denshi
Americast
Amstrad
Archer
Auna
Austar
BCC
Bell South
Bestlink
Birmingham Cable
Communications
British Telecom
Cable & Wireless
Century
Coship
Daehan
Daeryung
Digeo
Director
DX Antenna
Emerson
Encon
Fosgate
Foxtel
France Telecom
Freebox
Fujitsu
Galaxi
GE
Gehua
00008, 00144
00237, 00003, 00008
00003
00237
00237
00237
01230
01512
00899
01222
00237
01230
00276
00276
00899
00303
00276
00003
01068
00008
01462
00778
01877, 00877, 00477, 00008
01187
00476
01500
00303
00008
00276
01222
00817
01482
01497
00008
00237, 00144
00476
I
J
K
L
M
General Instrument
Gibralter
GNI
GoldStar
Hitachi
Hongtian Jiangsu
Hwalin
Insight
Jerrold
Jiuzhou
KNC
LG
Macab
Madritel
Maspro
Matav
Memorex
Mitsubishi
Motorola
N
O
P
MS
NEC
Noos
Nova Vision
Novaplex
NTL
Oak
Ono
Optus
Pace
Panasonic
Paragon
Penney
Philips
Pioneer
Q
R
S
Pulsar
PVP Stereo Visual
Matrix
Quasar
RadioShack
Regal
Runco
Sagem
Salora
Samsung
Scientific Atlanta
Skyworth
Sony
Sprucer
00476, 00810, 00276, 00003
00003
01466
00144
00003, 00008
01462
00303
00476, 00810
00476, 00810, 00276, 00003
01445
00008
00144
00817
01230
01510
01082
00000
00003
01376, 00476, 00810, 00276,
01187
00303
01496
00817
00008
00008
00276, 00003, 01060, 01068
00303
01068
00276, 01060
01877, 00877, 00237, 00008,
01060, 01068, 01577
00000, 00008, 00144, 01488
00000, 00008, 00525
00000
01305, 00317, 00817
01877, 00877, 00144, 00533,
01500
00000
00003
00000
00303
00276
00000
00817
00000
00003, 00000, 00144, 00778,
00840, 01060, 01666
01877, 00877, 00477, 00237,
00003, 00000, 00008, 01510
01464
01006, 01460
00144
T
U
V
Z
Starcom
StarHub
Sumitomo
Supercable
Taihan
TCL
Telewest
Time Warner cable
TongKook
Torx
Toshiba
Trans PX
TS
United Cable
US Electronics
Videoway
Visiopass
Zenith
00003
00276
01500, 01504
00276
00778
01445
01068
01877
00840
00003
00000, 01509
00276, 00303
00003, 00303
00276, 00003
00276, 00003, 00008
00000
00817
00000, 00525, 00899
California Audio Labs
Cambridge
Cambridge Audio
Cambridge
Soundworks
Carver
CDC
CEC
Copland
Curtis Mathes
Cyrus
D
F
G
Cable/PVR Combination b1
A
D
F
G
J
M
P
S
T
Z
Americast
Digeo
Freebox
General Instrument
Jerrold
Motorola
Pace
Pioneer
Scientific Atlanta
Sony
Supercable
Time Warner cable
Zenith
00899
01187
01482
00810
00810
01376, 00810, 01187
01877, 00237
01877, 00877
01877, 00877
01006
00276
01877
00899
H
I
J
K
L
CD Player
A
B
C
Acoustic Research
Advantage
Aiwa
Arcam
Audio Research
Audiolab
Audiomeca
Audioton
AVI
Balanced Audio
Technology
Burmester
Bush
Cairn
40420
40032
40157
40157
40157
40157
40157
40157
40157
40157
40420
40388
40157
M
Denon
DKK
DMX Electronics
Dual
Dynaco
Dynamic Bass
Fisher
Garrard
Genexxa
Goldmund
Grundig
Hafler
Harman/Kardon
Hitachi
Inkel
Integra
Jerrold
JVC
Kenwood
KLH
Krell
Linn
Loewe
Luxman
LXI
Magnavox
Marantz
Matsui
MCS
Memorex
Meridian
Micromega
Miro
Mission
Modulaire
MTC
Musical Fidelity
40029, 40303
40157
40157
40157
40157, 40179
40420
40420
40393
40032
40157
40873, 40003, 40766,
[42867]z, 42868
40000
40157
40003
40157
40179
40000, 40179
40393, 40420
40000, 40032, 40037, 40179
40157
40157
40173
40100, 40157, 40173
40032
40157
40101
40003
40032, 40072
40681, 40000, 40029, 40157,
40028, 40037, 40036, 40190
41318
40157
40157
40157
40393
40179
40157
40029, 40157
40157
40029
40000, 40032, 40179, 40420,
40468
40157
40157
40000
40157
40000, 40032, 40087, 40179,
40420, 40468
40420
40393
N
O
Myryad
NAD
Naim
NSM
Onkyo
Optimus
P
Q
R
Orion
Panasonic
Parasound
Penney
Philips
Pioneer
Polk Audio
Proceed
Proton
QED
Quad
Quasar
Radiola
RadioShack
RCA
Realistic
S
Restek
Revox
Roksan
Rotel
Royal
SAE
Saisho
Sansui
Sanyo
SAST
Sears
Sharp
Siemens
Silsonic
Simaudio
Sonic Frontiers
Sony
T
Sugden
Sylvania
TAG McLaren
Tandy
Tascam
Teac
Technics
Techwood
40157
40000, 40721
40157
40157
40868, 40101
40000, 40032, 40037, 40087,
40179, 40393, 40420, 40468
40393
40029, 40303, 40388, 40752
40420
40029
40157
40032, 40101, 40468
40157
40420
40157
40157
40157
40029
40157
40000, 40032, 40179, 40420,
40468
40032, 40053, 40179, 40420,
40468
40000, 40032, 40087, 40179,
40420, 40468
40157
40157
40420
40157, 40420
40420
40157
40000
40000, 40157
40000, 40087, 40179
40157
40179
40037
40157
40036
40157
40157
40490, 40000, 40100, 41364,
40185
40157
40157
40157
40032
40393, 40420
40490, 40393, 40420
40029, 40303
40303
PRESET CODE
8.AVR2808E2_PresetBack.indd
1
2007/09/28
12:59:15
U
V
W
Thomson
Thorens
Thule Audio
Tokai
Universum
Victor
Wadia
40053
40157
40157
40420
40157, 40053
40072
40393
40000, 40032, 40157, 40053,
40087, 40179
40490, 40868, 40032, 40036
40000
Wards
Y
Yamaha
Yorx
CD Recorder
D
J
R
S
T
Denon
JVC
RCA
Sony
Teac
Thomson
40766, 42868
40072
40053, 40420
40000, 40100, 41364
40420
40053
C
D
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
O
P
Aiwa
Akai
Arcam
Audiolab
Carver
20029, 20197, 20200, 21315
20283, 20439
20076
20029
20029
20076, 20371, 21311,
[22471]z
20074
20308, 20309, 20375, 20439
20439
20375
20029, 20375
20182, 20029, 21314
20070, 20071, 20337
20244, 20273, 20274, 20303,
20304, 20310, 21309
20070, 20071, 20092, 20233,
20234, 21364
20375
20308, 20309
20029
20029, 20009
20099
20283, 20439
20029
20135, 20136, 20282
20027, 20220, 20337, 20439
20308, 20309
20375
20229
20029, 20229
Denon
Fisher
Garrard
Genexxa
GoldStar
Grundig
Harman/Kardon
Inkel
JVC
Kenwood
LG
Luxman
Magnavox
Marantz
Memorex
Mitsubishi
Myryad
Onkyo
Optimus
Orion
Palladium
Panasonic
Philips
Pioneer
R
S
Polk Audio
Radiola
RCA
Revox
Sansui
Sanyo
Sharp
Sherwood
Sonic
Sony
Tape Deck
A
Phonotrend
T
TaeKwang
Tandberg
Teac
U
V
W
Y
Technics
Technovox
Thorens
Universum
Victor
Wards
Wharfedale
Yamaha
20337
20027, 20220, 20099, 20109,
21306, 21312
20029
20029
20027, 20220
20029
20029, 20009
20074
20231, 20371
20337
20375
20243, 20170, 20291, 20234,
21313
20439
20109
20280, 20283, 20289, 20308,
20309
20229
20229
20029
20375, 20439
20244, 20273, 20274
20027, 20029
20439
20097, 20094
HDTV Tuner b1
A
C
D
E
G
H
I
L
M
N
P
ABS
Accurian
Alienware
CyberPower
D-Link
Dgtec
Epson
Gateway
Hewlett Packard
Howard Computers
HP
Hush
iBUYPOWER
LG
Linksys
Media Center PC
Microsoft
Mind
Motorola
Niveus Media
Northgate
Packard Bell
Panasonic
Pioneer
01272
01653
01272
01272
01554
01363
01563
01272
01272, 01267
01272
01272, 01267
01272
01272
01415
01272, 01365
01272
01272, 01805
01272
01363
01272
01272
01272
01120
01010
R
S
T
V
X
Z
Ricavision
Samsung
Sensory Science
Sharp
SMC
Sony
Stack 9
Sylvania
Systemax
Tagar Systems
Toshiba
Touch
Viewsonic
Vizio
Voodoo
Xbox
ZT Group
01272
01190, 01490
01126
01010
01456
01272, 01324, 01364
01272
01563
01272
01272
01272
01272
01272, 01329
01126
01272
01805
01272
Astro
Atlantic Telephone
Atsat
AtSky
Audioline
Aurora
Austar
B
Satellite Receiver
A
@sat
@Sky
A-Mark
ABsat
ADB
AGS
Aiwa
Akai
Alba
Allsat
Alltech
Allvision
AlphaStar
Amitronica
Amstrad
Anglo
Ankaro
AntSat
Apollo
Arcon
Armstrong
Arnion
Asat
ASCI
ASLF
AssCom
Astacom
Aston
Astra
Astratec
01300
01334
00345
00123, 00713
00642, 01259, 01367, 01418,
01473, 01491
00710
01514
00200
00455, 00713, 01284, 01659,
01811
00200, 01043
00713
01232, 01334, 01412
00772
00713
00345, 00713, 00795, 00847,
00863, 00882, 01113, 01175,
01693, 01801
00713
00713
01083
00455
01043, 01075
00200
01300
00200
01334
00713
00853
00710
00142
00713
01743
Axiel
Axil
Axis
B@ytronic
Beko
Bell ExpressVu
Big Sat
Black Diamond
Blaupunkt
Blue Sky
Boca
Boston
Brainwave
British Sky
Broadcasting
Broco
BskyB
BT
Bubu Sat
Bush
C
Canal
Canal Digital
Canal Satellite
Canal+
Centrex
CGV
Chaparral
Cherokee
Chess
Chili
CityCom
Classic
Clatronic
CNS
Comag
Condor
Conia
Contec
Continental Edison
Coship
Crossdigital
Crown
Cryptovision
00173, 00658, 01099, 01100,
01113
01333
01300
01334
01672
00642, 00879, 01333, 01433
00497, 00642, 00863, 00879,
01176, 01259
00710
01457, 01659
01111
01412
00455
00775
01457
01284
00173
00713
00713, 01232, 01366
00710, 01251
00658, 01672
D
00847, 01175, 01662, 01847
00713
00847, 01175, 01662
00710, 01296
00713
01284, 01645, 01672, 01743,
01811
00853
00853, 01622
00853, 01339, 01853
00853
01457
01413, 01567
00216
00123, 00710
00713, 01085, 01334, 01626
01718
00299, 00394, 00818, 01075,
01176, 01232
01672
01413
01367
01232, 01366, 01412, 01413
01700
01695
00394
01695
01457
01109
01284
00455, 00795
E
Cyfra+
Cyrus
D-box
Daewoo
Delfa
Deltasat
Dgtec
Digenius
Digiality
Digifusion
DigiLogic
DigiQuest
DigiSat
Digisky
DigitAll World
Digiturk
Digiwave
Dijam
DiPro
01076
00200
00723, 00873, 01114
00713, 01111, 01296, 01743
00863
01075
01542, 01631, 01242
00299
01685
01645, 01743
01284
00863, 01300, 01457, 01473
01232
01457
01227
01076
01631
01296
01367, 01543
01377, 00392, 00566, 00639,
01639, 01142, 00247, 00749,
01749, 00724, 00819, 01856,
DirecTV
01076, 01108, 00099, 01109,
01414, 01442, 01609, 01392,
01640
Discovery
00710
Dish Network System 01505, 01005, 00775, 01775
Dishpro
01505, 01005, 00775, 01775
Distratel
01283, 01704
DMT
01075
DNT
00200
Dream Multimedia 01237
DSE
01375
DSTV
00642, 00879, 01433
Durabrand
01284
DX Antenna
01530
01505, 01005, 00775, 00455,
00610, 00713, 00853, 00871,
Echostar
01086, 01200, 01323, 01409,
01418, 01473, 01775
Einhell
00713
Elap
00713, 01567
Elsat
00713
Elta
00200, 01659
Emme Esse
00871
Energy Sistem
01631
Engel
00713, 01251
EP Sat
00455
Esat
00879
Eurieult
00882
PRESET CODE
8.AVR2808E2_PresetBack.indd
2
2007/09/28
12:59:16
F
G
H
Eurocrypt
EuroLine
Europa
Europhon
Eurosky
Eurostar
Eutelsat
Expressvu
Fenner
Ferguson
Finlandia
Finlux
Flair Mate
FMD
Force
Fortec Star
00455
01251
00863
00299
00262, 00299
00818
00713
00775, 01775
00713
00455, 01291, 01743
00455
00455
00713
01251, 01413, 01457
01101
01083
00455, 00497, 00795, 00879,
Foxtel
01162, 01176, 01356
Fracapro Planet
00871
Fracarro
00125, 00871
France Telecom
00871
Freesat
00882
FTE
00863
FTEmaximal
00713, 00863
00173, 00262, 00299, 00394,
Fuba
01214, 01251, 01801
Fugionkyo
00125
Funai
01377
00853, 00863, 01101, 01111,
Galaxis
01557
Gardiner
00818
Garnet
01075
GbSAT
01214
GE
00392, 00566
Gecco
01412
General Instrument 00869
General Satellite
01176
GF Good Friends
01043
GF Star
01043
01251, 01334, 01412, 01429,
Globo
01626
GOD Digital
00200
GOI
00775, 01775
Gold Box
00853
Gold Vision
01631
Golden Interstar
01283
GoldStar
00394
Goodmans
00455, 01284, 01291
Gradiente
00887
Granada
00455
00173, 00345, 00847, 00853,
Grundig
00879, 01291
Handan
01622
Hanseatic
01099, 01100
Hauppauge
HB
HDT
Hills
Hirschmann
Hisense
Hitachi
Homecast
Hornet
Houston
HTS
Hughes Network
Systems
Humax
I
J
K
Huth
Hyundai
iCan
ID Digital
ILLUSION sat
iLo
Imperial
Indovision
Ingelen
Innova
Interstar
InVideo
ISkyB
Italtel
ITT Nokia
Jadeworld
Jaeger
Jerrold
Jiuzhou
JOK
JVC
K-SAT
Kamm
Kaon
KaTelco
Kathrein
Kennex
Kenwood
Klap
Kocmoc TB
Koscom
Kosmos
Kreiling
01672
01214, 01801
01159
01232
00125, 00173, 00299, 00710,
00882, 01085, 01111, 01232,
01412
01535
00749, 00819, 00455, 01250,
01284, 01518, 01523, 01525
01214, 01680, 01700
01300
00775
00775, 01775
L
01142, 00749, 01749, 01442
00863, 01176, 01225, 01406,
01427, 01675, 01743, 01790,
01915
01075
01075, 01159
01367
01176
01557, 01631
01535
01334, 01429, 01672
00887
00882
00099
01214
00871
00887
00871
00455, 00723, 00873
00642
01334
00869
01450
00710
00775, 01507, 01531, 01775
00713
00713
01300
01111
00123, 00173, 00200, 00249,
00394, 00442, 00480, 00504,
00658, 00713, 00818, 01221,
01416, 01561, 01567
00125
00853
00710
01333
01043
00442, 01333
00249, 00658
M
Kreiselmeyer
Kross
L&S Electronic
Labgear
LaSAT
Lava
Legend
Legrand
Lemon
Lenco
Lenoxx
LG
Lifesat
Lodos
Logik
Logix
Lorenzen
Luxor
M Electronic
M vision
Magnavox
Manata
Manhattan
Marantz
Maspro
Master’s
Matsui
Maximum
McIntosh
MDS
Mediabox
Mediacom
MediaSa
Medion
Medison
Mega
Memorex
Metronic
Metz
MiCO
Micro
Micro Elektronic
Micro Technology
Micromaxx
Microstar
Microtec
Mitsubishi
Morgan’s
Motorola
MTEC
Muller
00173
01695
01043, 01334
01296
00173, 00299
01631
01718
01718
01334
00713
01611
01075, 01414
00299, 00713, 01043
01284
01284
01075
00299
00345, 00873
00818
01557
00724, 00722
00710, 00713
00455, 00710, 01083
00200
00173, 00713, 01530
00394
00173, 00710, 01284, 01743
01075, 01334, 01685
00869
01225
00853
01206
00853
00299, 00713, 01043, 01075,
01232, 01334, 01412, 01626
00713
00200
00724
00713, 00818, 01283, 01334,
01375, 01704
00173
01811
00713
00713
00713
00299
01075
00713
00749, 00455
00200, 00713, 01232, 01412
00869, 00856, 01473
01214
01695
Multibroadcast
Multichoice
N
Mx Onda
Myryad
Mysat
MySky
NEC
NEOTION
Netgem
Netsat
Neuf TV
Neuhaus
Neuling
Neusat
Nevir
Next Level
Nikko
Noda Electronic
Nokia
O
Nordmende
OctalTV
Okano
Omega
Opentel
Optex
P
Optimus
Optus
Orbis
Orbitech
Origo
OSAT
P/Sat
Pace
Pacific
Packard Bell
Packsat
Palcom
Panarex
Panasat
Panasonic
Panda
Pansat
Patriot
Paysat
peeKTon
00642, 00879
00642, 00879, 01333, 01433,
01559, 01560
01659
00200
00713
01693, 01848, 01850
01519
01334
01322
00099, 00887
01322
00713
01232
00713
01659
00869
00200, 00713, 00723
01704
00455, 00723, 00751, 00853,
00873, 01023, 01223, 01723
00455, 01611
01505
00442
00887
01232, 01412
00394, 00713, 01043, 01283,
01611
00724
00879
01232, 01334, 01412
01099, 01100
00497
00345
01232
00200, 00329, 00455, 00497,
00795, 00847, 00853, 00887,
01175, 01323, 01356, 01423,
01693, 01717, 01848, 01850
01284, 01375
01111
00710
00299, 01409
01159
00615, 00879, 01333, 01433
00247, 00701, 00455, 00847,
01304, 01404, 01508, 01526,
01527
00173, 00455
01159
00710
00724
01457
Philips
Phonotrend
Pilotime
Pino
Pioneer
Q
R
Planet
Plasmatic
PMB
Polytron
Portland
Preisner
Premier
Prima
Primacom
Primestar
Profile
Promax
Proscan
Proton
QNS
Quadral
Quelle
Radiola
RadioShack
Radix
RCA
S
Rebox
Regal
RFT
Roadstar
Rollmaster
Rover
Rownsonic
SAB
Saba
Sabre
Sagem
Samsung
Sat Control
Sat Team
SAT+
Satec
Satelco
Satplus
01142, 00749, 01749, 00775,
00724, 00819, 01076, 00722,
00099, 00710, 00455, 00818,
00200, 00847, 00853, 00173,
01114, 00133, 01442, 01543,
01672
00863, 01200
01339
01334
01142, 00329, 00853, 01308,
01442
00871
00442
00713, 01611
00394
01296
00262, 01101, 01113, 01366
00723, 00853, 00873, 01429
00795
01111
00869
00710
00455
00392, 00566
01535
01367, 01402, 01404
00710
00299
00200
00566, 00775, 00869
00394, 00882, 01113, 01317
00392, 00566, 01142, 00775,
00855, 00143, 01291, 01392,
01442
01214
01251
00200
00713, 00853
01413
00713
01567
01251
00710, 00820
00455
00820, 01114, 01253, 01307,
01690
01377, 01142, 01276, 01108,
01109, 00853, 00863, 01206,
01442, 01458, 01570, 01609,
01700, 01916
01300
00713
01409
00713
01232
01100
PRESET CODE
8.AVR2808E2_PresetBack.indd
3
2007/09/28
12:59:17
Satstation
Schaub Lorenz
Schneider
01083
01214
00710, 01206, 01251
00394, 00504, 00863, 01075,
Schwaiger
01083, 01111, 01317, 01334,
01412, 01457
SCS
00299
Sedea Electronique 00125, 01206, 01283, 01626
SEG
01075, 01087, 01251, 01626
Seleco
00871
Septimo
01375
Serd
01412
Serino
00610
Servimat
01611
ServiSat
00713, 01251
Sharp
01517
Siemens
00173, 01334, 01429
Silva
00299
Skantin
00713
SKR
00713
00856, 00099, 00847, 00887,
SKY
01014, 01175, 01662, 01693,
01847, 01848, 01850
SKY Italia
00853, 01693, 01847, 01848
Sky Television
01014
Sky XL
01251, 01412
Sky+
01175
00713, 01075, 01085, 01200,
Skymaster
01334, 01409, 01567, 01611
Skymax
00200
Skyplus
01232, 01334, 01412
SkySat
00713
Skyvision
01334
SL
00299, 01672
SM Electronic
00713, 01200, 01409
00713, 00882, 01101, 01113,
Smart
01232, 01404, 01413
00639, 01639, 00455, 00847,
Sony
00853, 01524, 01558, 01640
Star
00887
Star Choice
00869
Star Trak
00772, 00869
Starland
00713
Starlite
00200
Stream
01847, 01848
00125, 00713, 00820, 00853,
Strong
00879, 01159, 01284, 01300,
01409, 01626
Sunkai
00123
Sunny
01300
Sunsat
00713
Sunstar
00642
Supernova
00887
SVA
01455
Systec
01334
T
Tantec
Tarbs
Tatung
TBoston
Teac
Tecatel
TechniSat
Technomate
Technosonic
Technotrend
Techwood
Tele System
Electronic
Teleciel
TeleClub
Telefunken
Teleka
Telestar
Telesystem
Televes
Televisa
Telewire
Tevion
Thomson
Thorn
Tiny
Tioko
Tivo
Tokai
Tonna
Topfield
Toshiba
TPS
Triax
U
Trio
TT-micro
Turnsat
Twinner
UEC
UltimateTV
Uniden
Unisat
United
Universum
US Digital
USDTV
00455
01225
00455
01659
01225, 01227, 01251, 01322
01200
00262, 00455, 00863, 01099,
01100, 01195, 01197, 01322
01283, 01610
01672
01429
01284, 01626
V
Visiosat
01251, 01409, 01611, 01801
01043
01367
00710
00262, 00442
01099, 01100, 01251, 01334,
01610, 01626
01801
00455, 01214, 01300, 01334
00887
01232
00713, 01409, 01622, 01672
00392, 00566, 00455, 00710,
00713, 00820, 00847, 00853,
01046, 01175, 01291, 01534,
01543, 01662
00455
01672
00394
01142, 01442
00200
00455, 00713, 01611
01206, 01208, 01545, 01783
00749, 01749, 00790, 00819,
00455, 01285, 01501, 01516,
01530
00820, 01253, 01307
00200, 00713, 00853, 01113,
01227, 01251, 01291, 01296,
01626
01075
01429
00713
00713, 01611
00879, 01162, 01333, 01356
01392, 01640
00724, 00722
00200
01251
00173, 00299, 01087, 01099,
01251
01535
01535
Variosat
Ventana
Vestel
VH Sat
Viasat
ViewSat
Visionic
VisionNet
W
Viva
Vivid
Voom
VTech
Wavelength
Wewa
Wharfedale
Winbox
Wintel
Wisi
Worldsat
X
Xcom
XMS
Xsat
Y
Z
Xtreme
Yakumo
Yamada
Yes
Zehnder
Zenith
Zeta Technology
Zodiac
00173
00200
01251
00299
01682
01232
00125, 01283
01557
00142, 00710, 00713, 01413,
01457, 01718
00856
01162
00869
00818
01232, 01413
00455
01284
01801
00299
00173, 00299, 00455
00123, 00710, 01214, 01251,
01543
00123
01075
00123, 00713, 00847, 01214,
01323
01300
01413
01718
00887
00394, 00504, 00818, 01075,
01232, 01251, 01334, 01412,
01413
00856, 01856
00200
01801
Satellite Receiver/
PVR Combination b1, b3
E
F
G
H
K
L
M
N
O
P
b1
A
B
C
D
@sat
Allvision
Amstrad
Atsat
B@ytronic
British Sky
Broadcasting
BskyB
Bush
Canal Satellite
Comag
Digifusion
DigiQuest
Digiturk
01300
01412
01175
01300
01412
R
01175
S
01175, 01662
01645
01339
01412
01645
01300
01076
01377, 00392, 00639, 01142,
01076, 00099, 01392, 01442,
01640
Dish Network System 01505, 00775
Dishpro
01505, 00775
DMT
01075
Dream Multimedia 01237
Echostar
01505, 00775, 00610
Expressvu
00775
Foxtel
01356
GbSAT
01214
Gecco
01412
Globo
01412
HDT
01159
Hirschmann
01412
Homecast
01680
Hughes Network
01142, 01442
Systems
Humax
01176, 01427, 01675
Huth
01075
Hyundai
01075, 01159
Kaon
01300
Kathrein
00249, 00658, 01221, 01561
LG
01075
Maximum
01334
Mediacom
01206
Medion
01412
Microstar
01075
Morgan’s
01412
Motorola
00869
MTEC
01214
Multichoice
01333, 01559, 01560
MySky
01693, 01848, 01850
NEOTION
01334
Nokia
01023
Opentel
01412
Orbis
01412
Pace
01175, 01356, 01423, 01850
Panasonic
01304
Philips
01142, 00099, 01442
Pilotime
01339
Proscan
00392
Radix
01317
RCA
01392
Rebox
01214
Sagem
01253, 01307
Samsung
01206, 01442, 01570, 01609
Sat Control
01300
Schneider
01206
Schwaiger
01075, 01412
Sedea Electronique 01206
Serd
01412
SKY
01175, 01693, 01848, 01850
DirecTV
T
X
Z
SKY Italia
Sky XL
Skymaster
Skyplus
Sony
Star Choice
Strong
Sunny
TechniSat
Thomson
Topfield
TPS
Xtreme
Zehnder
01848
01412
01075
01412
00639, 01640
00869
01300
01300
01195, 01197
01175, 01534, 01662
01206, 01545, 01783
01253, 01307
01300
01075, 01412
Hughes Network
Systems
Philips
Samsung
20739
b3
H
P
S
20739
20739
Television
1
A
888
A-Mark
A.R. Systems
Accent
Accuscan
Accuscreen
Acoustic Research
Action
Acura
Addison
ADL
Admiral
Advent
Adventuri
Adyson
AEG
Agashi
Agna
Aiko
Aim
Aiwa
Akai
10264
10047, 10054, 10009
10037, 10352, 10374, 10455,
10556
10009, 10037
10047
10001
11269
10030, 10650
10009
10092, 10108, 10653
11217
10047, 10054, 10017, 10051,
10093, 10463, 10180, 10163,
10264, 10418
10761, 10783, 10815, 10817,
10842, 10876, 11933
10000
10217
11163, 11556
10217, 10264
10150
10092, 10009, 10035, 10037,
10217, 10264, 10361, 10371,
10433
10706, 10037, 10455, 10805
10264, 10701, 11904, 11911
10000, 10060, 10812, 10702,
10178, 10030, 10145, 10602,
10606, 10631, 10648, 10672,
10714, 10715, 11207, 11537,
11675, 11676, 11903, 10556,
10548, 10480, 10433, 10371,
10361, 10264, 10218, 10217,
10208, 10163, 10037, 10035,
10009
PRESET CODE
8.AVR2808E2_PresetBack.indd
4
2007/09/28
12:59:19
Akashi
Akiba
Akira
Akito
10009, 10860
10037, 10218, 10455
10418
10037
10171, 10009, 10037, 10163,
10218, 10264, 10668, 10714,
11037, 11498, 11556, 11982
10170
10009, 10036, 10037, 10073,
10163, 10218, 10352, 10370,
10371, 10418, 10443, 10487,
10668, 10714, 11037
10700, 10843
10672
10865, 11269
10030, 10170
10217
10037
10150
10180
10000, 10060
10217, 10370
10000, 10171, 10009, 10011,
10037, 10163, 10218, 10264,
10362, 10371, 10433, 10648,
11037, 11982
10000, 10180
10250, 10180, 10009, 10037,
10700, 10861
10250, 10037, 10650
11149, 11163
10009, 10264
10051
10009, 10037, 10264
10009, 10037, 10163, 10370,
10374, 10668
10451, 10093, 10180, 10060,
10178, 10030, 10092, 10009,
10108
10264
10156, 10748, 10879, 10765,
10767, 11217, 11943
10352, 10556
10109
10217
10037, 10714
10163
10037, 10556
11037
10163
10070
10037
10009
10037
10217, 10218, 10264
10698
10001, 10037
Akura
Alaron
Alba
Albatron
Alfide
All-Tel
Alleron
Allorgan
Allstar
Ambassador
America Action
American High
Amplivision
Amstrad
Amtron
Anam
Anam National
Andersson
Anglo
Anhua
Anitech
Ansonic
AOC
Aolinpike
Apex Digital
AR
Arc En Ciel
Arcam
Ardem
Aristocrat
Aristona
ART
Arthur Martin
ASA
Asberg
Asora
Astra
Asuka
ATD
Atlantic
Atori
Auchan
Audinac
Audiosonic
Audioton
Audiovox
Audioworld
Aumark
Autovox
Aventura
AVP
Awa
B
Axion
Axxent
Baier
Baihe
Baile
Baird
Bang & Olufsen
Baohuashi
Baosheng
Barco
Basic Line
Bastide
Bauer
Baur
Baysonic
Bazin
Beaumark
Beijing
Beko
Belcor
Bell & Howell
Belson
Belstar
BenQ
Beon
Berthen
Best
Bestar
Bestar-Daewoo
Binatone
Black Diamond
10009
10163
10180
10009, 10037, 10109, 10217,
10218, 10264, 10370, 10374,
10486, 10714, 10715, 10820
10217, 10264, 10370, 10486
10451, 10180, 10092, 10623,
10802, 10875, 11937, 11951,
11952
10698
10060
10217
10171
10000
10451, 10009, 10011, 10036,
10108, 10217, 10264, 10374,
10606
11937, 11958
10009
10876
10009, 10264
10001, 10009, 10374, 10661
10037, 10073, 10109, 10208,
10217, 10343, 11196
10565
10264
10009, 10817
10163, 10556
10009, 10037, 10163, 10217,
10218, 10374, 10455, 10556,
10668, 11037, 11163
10217
10805
10037, 10195, 10361, 10455,
10512
10180
10217
10017, 10178, 10030
10812, 10001, 10009, 10208,
10226, 10264, 10374, 10661,
10817, 10821
10037, 10195, 10370, 10418,
10486, 10606, 10714, 10715,
10808, 11037
10030
10054, 10017, 10154, 10093
10698, 11191
11037
11032, 11756
10037, 10163, 10218, 10418
10668
10370
10037, 10370, 10374
10374
10217
10614, 10820, 10821, 11037,
11163, 11909
Blackway
Blaupunkt
Blue Sky
Boots
BPL
Bradford
Brandt
Brinkmann
Brionvega
Britannia
Brockwood
Broksonic
Brother
BSR
BTC
Bush
C
Caihong
Cailing
Candle
Canton
Capehart
Capetronic
Capsonic
Carad
Carena
Carnivale
Carrefour
Carver
Cascade
Casio
Cathay
CCE
Celebrity
Celera
Celestial
Centrex
Centrum
Centurion
CGE
Changcheng
Changfei
Changfeng
Changhai
10218
10036, 10170, 10195, 10200,
10327, 10455
10037, 10218, 10455, 10487,
10499, 10556, 10668, 10714,
10715, 11037, 11191, 11363
10009, 10217
10037, 10208
10180
10109, 10287, 10335, 10560,
10625, 10714
10037, 10418, 10486, 10668
10037, 10362
10217
10178, 10030
10236, 10463, 10180, 11911,
11938
10264
10163
10218
11900, 11556, 11037, 10778,
10714, 10698, 10668, 10661,
10614, 10556, 10487, 10374,
10371, 10361, 10335, 10264,
10218, 10217, 10208, 10163,
10037, 10036, 10009
10009, 10817
10748
10030
10218
10017, 10178, 10030, 10092,
10036
10030
10264
10610, 10668, 11037
10037, 10455
10030
10036, 10037, 10070
10054, 10170
10009, 10037
10037
10037, 10218
10037, 10217
10000
10765
10767, 10819, 10820, 10821
10780
11037
10037
10074, 10163, 10370, 10418
10051, 10001, 10009, 10264,
10374, 10661, 10817
10009, 10374, 10817
10264, 10817
10009, 10817
10156, 10765, 10009, 10264,
10508, 10767, 10783, 10817,
10819, 10820, 10821, 11008,
11156
Chengdu
10009, 10817
Ching Tai
10092, 10009
10000, 10180, 10092, 10009,
Chun Yun
10700, 10843
Chunfeng
10009, 10264
Chung Hsin
10180, 10053, 10036, 10108
Chunsun
10009, 10817
Cimline
10009, 10218
Cinema
10672
Cineral
10451, 10092
Cinex
10648, 11556
Citek
10047
10054, 10000, 10451, 10463,
Citizen
10180, 10060, 10030, 10171,
10092, 10001, 10035
City
10009
Clarion
10180
Clarivox
10037, 10070, 10418
Classic
10030, 10092, 10499
10009, 10037, 10217, 10218,
Clatronic
10264, 10370, 10371, 10714
Clayton
11037
CMS Hightec
10217
10047, 10054, 10017, 10060,
Colortyme
10178, 10030
Commercial Solutions 11447, 10047
Concorde
10009
10009, 10037, 10264, 10370,
Condor
10418
Conia
10820, 10821, 11498
Conic
10178
Conrac
10808
10156, 10145, 10009, 10264,
Conrowa
10698, 11156, 11170
Contec
10180, 10009, 10036, 10037
Continental Edison 10109, 10287, 10487
Cosmel
10009, 10037
Craig
10180, 10171
10054, 10000, 10180, 10030,
Crosley
10171, 10074, 10163, 10370
10093, 10180, 10053, 10009,
10037, 10208, 10370, 10418,
Crown
10486, 10487, 10606, 10672,
10712, 10714, 10715, 11037
Crown Mustang
10672
CS Electronics
10218
CTX
11756
10047, 10054, 10154, 10000,
10051, 10451, 10093, 10180,
Curtis Mathes
10060, 10702, 10178, 10030,
10145, 10166, 10037, 10035,
11147, 11347
CXC
10180
Cybertron
10218
Cytronix
11298
D-Vision
10037, 10556, 11982
Changhong
D
Daewoo
Dainichi
Dansai
Dantax
Datsura
Dawa
Daytek
Dayton
Daytron
Dayu
De Graaf
Decca
Degraff
Deitron
Dell
Denko
Denon
Denver
Desmet
Diamant
Diamond
Digatron
Digiline
Digital Life
Digitex
Digitor
Digix Media
Dixi
DL
Domeos
Domland
Dongda
Donghai
Dream Vision
DSE
DTS
Dual
Dual Tec
Dumont
Durabrand
Dux
Dwin
Dynatech
Dynatron
10154, 10451, 10180, 10178,
10030, 10092, 11661, 10634,
10661, 10672, 10700, 10860,
10865, 10876, 10880, 11755,
11756, 11909, 10623, 10556,
10499, 10374, 10264, 10218,
10217, 10170, 10109, 10108,
10037, 10036, 10009
10218
10009, 10035, 10036, 10037,
10208, 10217
10370, 10486, 10714, 10715
10208
10009, 10037
10672, 11207
10092, 10009, 11207
10180, 10178, 10030, 10092,
10009, 10036, 10037, 10374
10374, 10661
10163, 10208, 10548
10037, 10217
10163, 10208
10374
11080, 11178
10264
10145, 10511
10037, 10587
10009, 10037
10037
10706, 10009, 10371, 10672,
10698, 10820, 10860
10037
10037, 10668
10872
10820
10037
10880
10009, 10037, 10217
10587, 10780, 10872
10668
10394
10009
10009
11164, 11704
10698, 10820, 11556
10009
10037, 10217, 10343, 10352,
10394, 11037, 11137
10217
10017, 10180, 10178, 10070,
10217
10463, 10180, 10178, 10171,
11034, 11463
10037
10093
10217
10037
PRESET CODE
8.AVR2808E2_PresetBack.indd
5
2007/09/28
12:59:20
E
F
Easy Living
Eaton
Ecco
ECE
Edison-Minerva
11248
10060
10773
10037
10487
10037, 10217, 10218, 10362,
Elbe
10610
Elcit
10163
Electroband
10000
Electrograph
11755
10154, 10000, 10463, 10150,
Electrohome
10178, 10030, 10073
Elekta
10009, 10264
Elfunk
11037, 11208
ELG
10037
Elin
10009, 10037, 10361, 10548
Elite
10037, 10218
Elta
10009, 10264
Emerald
10178
10047, 10017, 10154, 10451,
10236, 10463, 10180, 10150,
10178, 10171, 11944, 11911,
Emerson
11909, 10714, 10668, 10623,
10486, 10036, 10371, 10370,
10361, 10037, 10195, 10170,
10070, 10073
Envision
10030, 10813
Enzer
10860
Erae
11371
Erres
10037
ESA
10812, 10171, 11944
ESC
10037, 10217
Ether
10030, 10009
Etron
10001, 10009, 10163, 10820
Eurofeel
10217, 10264
Euroman
10037, 10217, 10264, 10370
Europa
10037
Europhon
10037, 10109, 10217
Evesham Technology 11248
Evolution
11756
Expert
10163
Exquisit
10037
Feilang
10009
Feilu
10009, 10817
Feiyan
10264
Feiyue
10009, 10817
Fenner
10009, 10374
Fer0
10335
10053, 10037, 10073, 10109,
10195, 10287, 10335, 10343,
Ferguson
10443, 10548, 10560, 10625,
11037
10171, 10037, 10163, 10217,
Fidelity
10264, 10361, 10371, 10512
Filsai
10217
10163, 10208, 10346, 10361,
Finlandia
10548
Finlux
Firstar
Firstline
Fisher
Flint
Force
Formenti
Fortress
Fraba
Friac
Frontech
Fujimaro
Fujitsu
Fujitsu General
Fujitsu Siemens
Funai
G
Furi
Furichi
Futronic
Futuretech
Galaxi
Galaxis
Ganxin
Gateway
GBC
GE
GEC
Geloso
Gemini
General
General Technic
Genesis
Genexxa
Gericom
Gevalt
Giant
Gibralter
Go Video
Go Vision
Goldfunk
GoldStar
10037, 10070, 10163, 10217,
10346, 10480, 10556, 10631,
10714, 10715, 10808, 11556
10236, 10009
10009, 10037, 10208, 10217,
10361, 10374, 10556, 10668,
10714, 10808, 11037, 11191,
11363, 11371
10047, 10054, 10154, 10000,
10036, 10208, 10217, 10361,
10370
10037, 10218, 10264, 10455,
10610
11149
10037, 10163
10093
10037, 10370
10009, 10037, 10370, 10499,
10610
10009, 10163, 10217, 10264
10865, 11498
10009, 10217, 10352, 10683,
10809, 10853
10009, 10217, 10683
10808, 10809, 11163, 11298
10000, 10180, 10171, 10264,
10668, 11271, 11904
10145, 10264, 10817
10860
10264, 10860
10180
10037
10037, 10370
10817
11755, 11756
10009, 10163, 10218, 10374
11447, 10047, 11454, 10000,
10051, 10451, 10093, 10180,
10060, 10178, 10030, 10092,
11922, 11917, 11347, 11147,
10625, 10560, 10335, 10035
10037, 10163, 10217, 10361
10009, 10163, 10374
10047
10109, 10287
10009
10009, 10037
10009, 10037, 10163, 10218
10808, 10865, 10880, 11217,
11298
11371
10009, 10217
10017, 10000, 10030
10060, 10886
11937
10668
10047, 10054, 10154, 10178,
10030, 10715, 10714, 10606,
10455, 10361, 10217, 10163,
10109, 10073, 10037, 10036,
10009, 10001
Gooding
Goodmans
Gorenje
GPM
Gradiente
Graetz
Gran Prix
Granada
Grandin
Gronic
Grundig
H
Grundy
Grunkel
Grunpy
H&B
Haaz
Haier
Haihong
Haiyan
Halifax
Hallmark
Hampton
Hanimex
Hankook
Hanseatic
Hantarex
Hantor
Harley Davidson
Harman/Kardon
Harsper
Harvard
Harwa
Harwood
Hauppauge
Havermy
HCM
Heathkit
Helios
Hello Kitty
10487
10000, 11909, 11900, 11163,
11037, 10880, 10808, 10714,
10668, 10661, 10634, 10625,
10587, 10560, 10556, 10499,
10487, 10480, 10374, 10371,
10343, 10335, 10264, 10218,
10217, 10037, 10036, 10035,
10011, 10009
10370
10218
10053, 10037, 10170
10163, 10361, 10371, 10487,
10714, 11163
10648
10036, 10037, 10108, 10163,
10208, 10217, 10226, 10343,
10548, 10560
10009, 10037, 10163, 10218,
10374, 10455, 10610, 10668,
10714, 10715, 10865, 10880,
11037, 11191
10217
10706, 10009, 10036, 10037,
10070, 10163, 10195, 10443,
10487, 10556, 10587, 10672,
10683, 11371
10180, 10195
11163
10180
10808
10706
11034, 10037, 10508, 10587,
10698, 11017
10009
10264, 10817
10217, 10264
10236, 10180, 10178
10217
10218
10180, 10178, 10030
10009, 10037, 10217, 10361,
10370, 10394, 10499, 10556,
10634, 10661, 10714, 10808
10009, 10037, 10865
10037
10000, 10180, 10060, 10178,
10030, 11904
10054
10865
10180
10773, 11196, 11269
10009, 10037, 10487
10037
10093
10009, 10037, 10217, 10218,
10264, 10418
10017
10865
10451
Hema
Hewlett Packard
Hifivox
Highline
Hikona
Hikone
Hinari
Hisawa
Hisense
Hitachi
Hitachi Fujian
Hitec
Hitsu
Hoeher
Home Electronics
Hongmei
Hongyan
Hornyphon
Hoshai
HP
Hua Tun
Huafa
Huanghaimei
Huanghe
Huanglong
Huangshan
Huanyu
Huaqiang
Huari
Hugoson
Huodateji
Hygashi
Hyper
Hypersonic
Hypson
Hyundai
I
Iberia
ICE
ICeS
Iiyama
10009, 10217
11494, 11502
10109
10037, 10264
10218
10218
10009, 10036, 10037, 10163,
10208, 10218, 10264, 10352,
10443
10218, 10455, 10610, 10714
10156, 10748, 10145, 10009,
10208, 10508, 10556, 10780,
10821, 10860, 11022, 11156,
11170, 11208, 11363
10047, 10054, 10017, 10000,
11256, 10156, 10051, 10150,
10178, 10030, 11145, 10145,
10092, 10744, 10877, 10634,
11037, 11137, 11149, 11156,
11170, 11225, 11576, 11904,
11960, 10578, 10548, 10508,
10499, 10481, 10480, 10343,
10217, 10163, 10109, 10108,
10037, 10036, 10035, 10009
10150, 10108, 10860
10698
10009, 10218, 10455, 10610
10714, 10865, 11163, 11556
10606
10093, 10009, 10264, 10817
10264, 10817
10037
10218, 10455
11494, 11502
10009
10145, 10009
10009
10009, 10817
10009
10009, 10264, 10817
10217, 10264, 10374, 10817
10264
10145, 10264
11217
10051
10217
10009, 10217
10361
10037, 10217, 10264, 10455,
10486, 10556, 10668, 10714,
10715, 11037
10849, 10860, 10865, 10876,
11556
10037
10037, 10217, 10218, 10264,
10371
10218
10877, 11217
Ima
Imperial
Imperial Crown
Indiana
Infinity
InFocus
Ingelen
Ingersol
Inno Hit
Innova
Innowert
Inotech
Insignia
Inteq
Interbuy
Interfunk
Internal
Intervision
Irradio
Isukai
ITC
ITS
ITT
ITT Nokia
J
ITV
IX
JBL
JCB
JDV
Jean
JEC
Jensen
Jiahua
JiaLiCai
JIL
Jinfeng
Jinque
Jinta
Jinxing
JMB
JNC
Jocel
Johnson
Jubilee
Juhua
Jutan
10236, 10180, 10178
10037, 10074, 10370, 10418
10001, 10009, 10264, 10374,
10661
10037
10054
11164
10163, 10487, 10610, 10714
10009
10009, 10217, 10218, 11163
10037
10865, 11298
10773, 10820
10171, 11517
10017, 10145
10009, 10037, 10264
10037, 10109, 10163, 10200,
10327, 10361, 10512
10037, 11909
10009, 10037, 10217, 10218,
10264, 10394, 10455, 10486,
10487
10009, 10037, 10218, 10371
10037, 10218, 10455
10217
10037, 10218, 10264, 10371
10163, 10208, 10346, 10361,
10480, 10548, 10610
10070, 10163, 10195, 10208,
10346, 10361, 10480, 10548,
10606, 10610
10037, 10264, 10374
10877
10054
10000
11982
10156, 10051, 10236, 10092,
10009, 10036
10035
10761, 10815, 10817, 11933
10051
10009, 10264
10030
10051, 10208, 10226, 10817
10009, 10264, 10817
10009, 10264
10054, 10156, 10145, 10009,
10037, 10264, 10556, 10698,
10817, 10821, 11011
10443, 10499, 10556, 10634
10876
10712
10455
10556
10264, 10817
10030
PRESET CODE
8.AVR2808E2_PresetBack.indd
6
2007/09/28
12:59:21
10054, 10093, 10463, 10053,
10030, 10070, 10036, 10218,
10371, 10418, 10508, 10606,
10650, 10653, 10683, 10731,
11253, 11923
10009, 10264, 10817
10009, 10037, 10217, 10218,
10455
10217
10017, 10180, 10217
10001, 10009, 10264, 10374,
10661, 10817
10009, 10264
10163, 10361
10264, 10370, 10606, 10610,
10714, 10778, 11556
10556
10371
10030
10163
11498
10180, 10060
10037, 10362, 10370, 10610,
10648, 11037
10163
10668, 11037
10180, 10030
10706
10217
10001, 10371, 10455
10706, 10556
10037, 10668
10156, 10180, 10765, 10767,
11962
10037
10030
10037, 10362, 10370, 10374,
10499, 10556, 10610
10180, 10150, 10053, 10036,
10108, 11331
10037, 10218
10009, 10264, 10817
10009
10037
10180, 10037, 10218, 10371,
10418, 10587, 10641, 10714,
10817, 11084
10487
10037
10370
10037
10009
10876
10463, 10180, 10030, 10217
10009, 10264
10009
10051, 10208, 10226, 10264,
10374, 10661, 10817
JVC
K
Kaige
Kaisui
Kambrook
Kamp
Kangli
Kangyi
Kapsch
Karcher
Kathrein
Kawa
Kawasho
KB Aristocrat
KDS
KEC
Kendo
Kennedy
Kennex
Kenwood
Khind
KIC
Kiota
Kioto
Kiton
KLH
KLL
Kloss
Kneissel
Kolin
Kolster
Kongque
Konichi
Konig
Konka
Kontakt
Korpel
Korting
Kosmos
Koyoda
Kreisen
KTV
Kuaile
Kulun
Kunlun
L
Kyoshu
Kyoto
L&S Electronic
Lark
LaSAT
Lavis
Leader
Lecson
Legend
Lenco
Lenoir
Lexsor
Leyco
LG
Liesenk & Tter
Liesenkotter
Lifetec
Lihua
Lloyd’s
Local India TV
Local Malaysia TV
Lodos
Loewe
Logik
Logix
Longjiang
Luker
Luma
Lumatron
Lux May
Luxor
LXI
M
M Electronic
Madison
MAG
Magnadyne
Magnafon
Magnasonic
10418
10163, 10217
10714, 10808, 10865
10154
10486
11037
10009
10037
10009
10037, 10374, 10587
10009
11196
10037, 10264
10054, 11265, 10060, 10178,
10030, 11758, 11637, 11191,
11178, 10856, 10715, 10714,
10700, 10698, 10556, 10370,
10361, 10217, 10163, 10109,
10108, 10037, 10009, 10001
10037
10037, 10327
10009, 10037, 10218, 10374,
10668, 10683, 10714, 11037,
11137
10817
10236, 10180, 10030, 10001,
10009, 11904
10009, 10208, 10602
10698
11037
10037, 10370, 10512, 10633,
10790
10236, 10180, 10060, 10001,
10009, 10011, 10371, 10698,
10773, 10880, 11037, 11217
10668
10264, 10817
11982
10009, 10163, 10362, 10374,
11037
10037, 10073, 10163, 10217,
10264, 10361, 10556
10009, 10037
10163, 10208, 10217, 10346,
10361, 10480, 10548, 10631,
11037, 11163
10047, 10054, 10017, 10154,
10000, 10156, 10051, 10093,
10060, 10053, 10178, 10030,
10171, 10166, 10037, 10036,
10035, 10001, 10208
10009, 10037, 10109, 10163,
10195, 10217, 10287, 10343,
10346, 10374, 10480, 10512,
10634, 10661, 10714
10037
11498
10054, 10163
10073
10054, 10000, 10156, 10093,
10030, 10092, 10109
Magnavox
Magnum
Majestic
Mandor
Manesth
Manhattan
Marantz
Mark
Master’s
Mastro
Masuda
Matsui
Matsushita
Maxdorf
Maxent
Maxim
MCE
Meck
Mediator
Medion
Megapower
Megas
Megatron
MEI
Meile
Memorex
Memphis
Mercury
Mermaid
Metronic
Metz
MGA
MGN Technology
Micro Genius
Micromaxx
Microstar
MicroTEK
Midland
Mikomi
10047, 11454, 10054, 10154,
10000, 10250, 10051, 10180,
10060, 10030, 10171, 10092,
10706, 11944, 11904, 11755,
11254, 10802, 10780, 10011,
10035, 10037, 10036
10037, 10648, 10714, 10715
10017
10264
10035, 10037, 10217, 10264
10037, 10668, 10778, 10876,
11037, 11267
11454, 10054, 10030, 10037,
10556, 10704, 10855
10009, 10037, 10217, 10374,
10714, 10715
10499
10053, 10706, 10698, 10780
10009, 10037, 10217, 10218,
10264, 10371
11037, 10744, 10714, 10556,
10487, 10455, 10443, 10433,
10371, 10352, 10335, 10217,
10208, 10195, 10163, 10037,
10036, 10035, 10011, 10009
10250, 10051, 10650
10773
11755, 11756
11556, 11982
10009
10698
10037, 10556
10037, 10512, 10556, 10668,
10698, 10714, 10808, 10880,
11037, 11137, 11248, 11900
10700
10610
10047, 10178, 10145, 10009
11037
10264, 10817
10154, 10250, 10463, 10180,
10150, 10060, 10178, 10030,
10009, 10035, 10037, 10195,
10877, 11037, 11911
10009
10060, 10001, 10009, 10037
10037
10625
10037, 10195, 10367, 10388,
10447, 10587, 10668, 10746,
11163
10150, 10178, 10030, 10218,
10374
10178
10150
10037, 10668, 10714, 10808,
11037
10808
10820, 10860
10047, 10017, 10051
11037, 11149
Minato
Minerva
Minoka
Mirror
Mitsubishi
Mivar
Monaco
Monivision
Morgan’s
Motorola
MTC
MTlogic
Mudan
Multitec
Multitech
Murphy
Musikland
Mx Onda
Myryad
N
NAD
Naiko
Nakimura
Nanbao
Nansheng
Narita
NAT
National
NEC
Neckermann
NEI
Neovia
Netsat
NetTV
Neufunk
New Tech
New World
Newave
Nikkai
Nikkei
Nikko
Nikkodo
10037, 10556
10070, 10108, 10195, 10487
10037
11900
10154, 10250, 10093, 10236,
10180, 11250, 10150, 10178,
10030, 11917, 11037, 10836,
10817, 10556, 10512, 10195,
10108, 10037, 10036, 10011
10217
10009
10700, 10843
10037
10054, 10051, 10093, 10150
10180, 10060, 10030, 10092,
10011, 10370, 10512
10714
10051, 10009, 10208, 10226,
10264, 10817
10037, 10486, 10668, 11037,
11556
10180, 10009, 10037, 10217,
10264, 10370, 10486
10163
10218
11498
10556
10156, 10178, 10166, 10037,
10361, 10866, 11156
10037, 10606, 11982
10037, 10374
10009, 10264
10264, 10817
11982
10226
10051, 10208, 10226, 10508
10047, 10154, 10156, 10051,
10053, 10178, 10030, 11704,
11270, 11170, 10817, 10704,
10661, 10653, 10508, 10499,
10455, 10374, 10264, 10217,
10170, 10036, 10011, 10009
10037, 10200, 10327, 10370,
10418, 10556
10037, 10163, 10371
10865, 10876, 11371
10037
11755
10009, 10037, 10218, 10556,
10610, 10714
10009, 10037, 10217, 10343,
10556
10218
10093, 10178, 10092, 10009
10009, 10035, 10036, 10037,
10163, 10217, 10218, 10264
10714
10178, 10030, 10092
10178, 10030, 10092
Nishi
Nobliko
Nogamatic
Nokia
Norcent
Nordic
Nordmende
O
Normerel
Novatronic
NTC
Nu-Tec
Nyon
Oceanic
Odeon
Okano
Olevia
Omega
Omni
Onida
Onimax
Onwa
Opera
Optimus
Optoma
Optonica
Orbit
Orcom
Orion
Orline
Ormond
Osaki
Osio
Oso
Osume
Otic
Otto Versand
P
Pace
Pacific
Palladium
Palsonic
Panama
Panashiba
10030
10070
10109
10163, 10208, 10346, 10361,
10374, 10480, 10548, 10606,
10610, 10631
10748, 10824
10217
10037, 10109, 10195, 10287,
10343, 10560, 10714
10037
10037, 10374
10092
10455, 10698, 10820
10000
10163, 10208, 10361, 10548
10264
10009, 10037, 10264, 10370
11144, 11240, 11331, 11610
10264
10748, 10698, 10780, 10872
10053, 11253
10714
10180, 10218, 10371, 10433,
10602
10037
10154, 10250, 10093, 10180,
10150, 10178, 10030, 10166,
10650
10887
10093
10037
11504
10017, 10236, 10463, 10180,
10178, 11463, 10011, 10037,
10264, 10443, 10556, 10714,
10880, 11196, 11911
10037, 10218
10668, 11037
10037, 10217, 10218, 10264,
10374, 10556
10037
10218
10036, 10037, 10218
11498
10093, 10036, 10037, 10109,
10195, 10217, 10226, 10343,
10361, 10512, 10556
10092
10037, 10443, 10556, 10714,
11037, 11137
10037, 10163, 10200, 10217,
10327, 10370, 10418, 10556,
10714, 11137
10001, 10037, 10217, 10218,
10264, 10418, 10698, 10773,
10778, 11196, 11269, 11904
10009, 10037, 10217, 10264
10001
PRESET CODE
8.AVR2808E2_PresetBack.indd
7
2007/09/28
12:59:22
Panasonic
Panavision
Panda
Pathe Cinema
Pathe Marconi
Pausa
Paxonic
PCE
Penney
Perdio
Perfekt
Petters
Philco
Philharmonic
Philips
Phocus
Phoenix
Phonola
Pilot
Pioneer
Pionier
Plantron
Playsonic
Polaroid
Poppy
Portland
Powerpoint
Prandoni-Prince
Precision
Premier
President
Prima
Princeton
Prinston
Prinz
Prism
10054, 10000, 10156, 10250,
10051, 10236, 10030, 11947,
11946, 11941, 11480, 11310,
11291, 11271, 10853, 10650,
10548, 10508, 10367, 10361,
10226, 10208, 10163, 10108,
10037, 10035
10037
10051, 10706, 10009, 10208,
10226, 10264, 10508, 10698,
10780, 10817, 10821
10163
10109
10009
10060, 10030
Profex
Profi
Profilo
Profitronic
10156, 10060
10047, 10000, 10156, 10250,
10051, 10060, 10178, 10030,
10035, 10036, 10037, 10070,
10108, 11347
10037, 10163
10037
11523
10054, 10451, 10463, 10180,
10178, 10030, 10145, 11661,
10037, 10074, 10163, 10370,
10418
10217
11454, 10054, 10017, 10000,
10051, 10178, 10030, 10171,
10092, 11961, 11756, 11254,
10690, 10556, 10512, 10374,
10361, 10343, 10200, 10108,
10037, 10009
10714
10037, 10163, 10370, 10486
10037, 10556
10051, 10060, 10178, 10030,
10706, 10011
10166, 10011, 10037, 10109,
10163, 10170, 10287, 10361,
10370, 10486, 10512, 10679,
10760, 10866, 11260
10370, 10486, 11556
10009, 10037, 10264
10037, 10217, 10714, 10715
10765, 10865, 11276, 11316,
11341, 11498, 11523
10009
10451, 10092, 10374
10037, 10487, 10698
10361
10236, 10180, 10217
10009, 10264
10860
10761, 10009, 10264, 10783,
10815, 10817, 11269, 11933
10700
11037
10361
10250, 10051
Proton
10009, 10163, 10361
10009
11556
10037
10037, 10073, 10625, 10634,
11037
11447, 10047, 11347, 11922
10156
10037, 10217, 10370, 10371,
10374, 10668, 10714
10009, 10037, 10217, 10264
10009, 10037, 10217, 10264,
10418, 10486, 10668, 11037
10178, 10030, 10001, 10009
Proview
11498
ProVision
Pulsar
Pulser
Pvision
Pye
Pymi
10037, 10556, 10714, 11037
10017, 10092
10178, 10092
10876, 11191
10037, 10374, 10556
10009
10051, 10208, 10226, 10264,
10817
10051, 10218
10150, 10178
10250, 10051, 10009, 10035,
10650, 10865
10011, 10037, 10070, 10074,
10109, 10195, 10200, 10327,
10361, 10512, 10668, 11037
10036
10036
10037
10047
10163, 10218
10037, 10217, 10556
10037
10047, 10154, 10180, 10150,
10178, 10030, 10037, 11904
10009, 10037, 10264, 10370,
10418, 10648, 10668, 11037
10070
10036, 10602
10070
11447, 10047, 11454, 10054,
10000, 10051, 10093, 10178,
10030, 10092, 11958, 11953,
11948, 11922, 11917, 11547,
11347, 11247, 11147, 11047,
10679, 10625, 10560, 10090
10047, 10154, 10180, 10150,
10178, 10030
10037, 10418
10037
10036, 10163, 10346, 10361,
10548
10037
10037, 10668, 11037
10865, 10876, 10877, 11207,
11298
Proline
Proscan
Prosco
Prosonic
Protec
Protech
Q
Qingdao
Quadral
Quartz
Quasar
Quelle
R
Questa
Questar
R-Line
Rabbit
Radialva
Radiola
Radiomarelli
RadioShack
Radiotone
Rank
Rank Arena
RBM
RCA
Realistic
Recor
Rectiligne
Rediffusion
Redstar
Reflex
Relisys
Remotec
Reoc
Revox
Rex
RFT
Rinex
Roadstar
Rolson
Rover
Rowa
Royal Lux
Runco
Ruyi
S
Saba
Sagem
Saige
Saisho
Saivod
Sakai
Sakyno
Salora
Salsa
Sampo
Samsung
Sandra
Sanjian
Sanky
Sansui
Santon
Sanyo
Sanyong
Sanyuan
Saville
10250, 10093, 10145, 10171,
10037
10714
10037
10163, 10264
10037, 10264
10773
10009, 10037, 10218, 10264,
10418, 10668, 10714, 11037,
11900
11371
10036, 10877
10748, 10009, 10037, 10264,
10587, 10698, 10712, 10817
10335, 10370
10017, 10060, 10030
10817
10250, 10109, 10163, 10287,
10335, 10343, 10361, 10498,
10548, 10560, 10625, 10714
10455, 10610, 10618
10009, 10817
10009, 10011, 10163, 10217,
10264
10037, 10668, 10712, 11037,
11163, 11556, 11982
10163
10455
10163, 10208, 10361, 10480,
10548, 10631
10335
10047, 10154, 10093, 10178,
10030, 10171, 10092, 10009,
10036, 10650, 10700, 11755,
11756
10047, 10054, 10017, 10154,
10156, 10093, 10060, 10812,
10702, 10178, 10030, 10092,
10814, 10766, 10718, 10618,
10587, 10817, 10821, 11060,
11249, 11312, 11903, 11959,
10556, 10371, 10370, 10362,
10264, 10226, 10217, 10208,
10163, 10090, 10037, 10036,
10035, 10009
10217
10264
10060, 10030
10463, 10060, 10030, 10706,
10037, 10371, 10455, 10602,
10714, 10861, 11371, 11537,
11904, 11911
10009
10047, 10054, 10154, 10000,
10156, 10463, 10180, 10145,
10171, 11755, 11208, 10704,
10508, 10370, 10264, 10217,
10208, 10170, 10163, 10108,
10088, 10037, 10036, 10011,
10009
10037
10093, 10009, 10817
10060
SBR
Sceptre
Schaub Lorenz
Schneider
Scotch
Scotland
Scott
Sears
Seaway
Seelver
SEG
SEI
Sei-Sinudyne
Seleco
Semivox
Semp
Sencora
Sentra
Serino
Shancha
Shanghai
Shaofeng
Sharp
Shen Ying
Shencai
Sheng Chia
Shenyang
Sherwood
Shintoshi
Shivaki
Show
Siarem
Siemens
Siera
Siesta
Signature
Silva
Silva Schneider
Silvano
Silver
SilverCrest
10037, 10556
11217
10361, 10374, 10486, 10548,
10606, 10714, 11191
11982, 11904, 11137, 11037,
10714, 10668, 10648, 10556,
10394, 10371, 10361, 10352,
10343, 10218, 10217, 10163,
10070, 10037
10178
10163
10236, 10180, 10178, 10030
10047, 10054, 10017, 10154,
10000, 10156, 10051, 10093,
10060, 10053, 10178, 10030,
10171, 10166, 10035, 10036,
10037, 10001, 10208, 11904
10634
11037
10009, 10036, 10037, 10217,
10218, 10264, 10362, 10487,
10668, 11037, 11163
10037, 10163
10037
10163, 10264, 10346, 10362,
10371
10180
10156
10009
10035
10093, 10455, 10610
10264, 10817
10009, 10208, 10226, 10264,
10817
10145, 10817
10054, 10093, 10180, 10053,
10030, 10009, 10036, 10200,
10650, 10653, 10668, 11193,
11393, 11917
10092, 10009
10145, 10009, 10264
10093, 10236, 10009
10009, 10264, 10817
10009
10037
10178, 10037, 10374, 10443,
10556
10009, 10418
10163
10145, 10037, 10195, 10200,
10327
10037, 10556
10370
10047, 10093, 10030
10037, 10361, 10648
10037, 11556
10587
10036, 10361, 10455, 10715
11037
Simpson
10178, 10030, 10011
10060, 10092, 10009, 10037,
10335, 10371, 10433, 11537
Sinotec
10773
Sinudyne
10037, 10163, 10361
Skantic
10163
SKY
10037, 10880, 11504
Sky Brazil
10880
Sky-North
10037
Skygiant
10180
10748, 10009, 10037, 10264,
Skyworth
10698, 10805, 10817, 11115
Sliding
10865, 10880
SLX
10668
Smaragd
10487
Soemtron
10865, 11298
Solar Drape
10000
Solavox
10037, 10163, 10361, 10548
Sole
10813
Sonawa
10218
Songba
10009
Soniko
10037
Sonitron
10208, 10217, 10370
Sonneclair
10037
Sonoko
10009, 10037, 10217, 10264
Sonolor
10163, 10208, 10361, 10548
Sontec
10009, 10037, 10370
10017, 10154, 11100, 10000,
10150, 10053, 10011, 10036,
Sony
10037, 10074, 10353, 10650,
11505, 11651, 11751, 11904
Sound & Vision
10218, 10374
Soundesign
10180, 10178
Soundwave
10037, 10418, 10715
Sova
11952
10156, 10051, 10060, 10178,
Sowa
10092, 10036, 10226
Soyea
10773
Spectra
10009
Spectravision
10156, 10178
Spectroniq
11498
Squareview
10171
SR2000
10154, 10171
Ssangyong
10009
SSS
10180
Staksonic
10009
10009, 10037, 10217, 10218,
Standard
10374, 11037
Standard Components 10009, 10218
10236, 10180, 10009, 10037,
Starlite
10163, 10264
Stenway
10218
Stern
10163, 10264
Stevison
11982
Strato
10009, 10037, 10264
Singer
PRESET CODE
8.AVR2808E2_PresetBack.indd
8
2007/09/28
12:59:24
Strong
Studio Experience
Stylandia
Sunkai
Sunstar
Sunwatt
Sunwood
Superla
Superscan
Supersonic
SuperTech
Supra
Supreme
Susumu
Sutron
SV2000
SVA
Svasa
Swisstec
Sydney
Sylvania
Symphonic
Synco
T
Syntax
Sysline
T+A
Tacico
Tai Yi
Taishan
Tandberg
Tandy
Targa
Tashiko
Tatung
TCL
TCM
Teac
Tec
Tech Line
Techica
Technica
11149, 11163
10843
10217
10218, 10455, 10487, 10610,
10865
10009, 10037, 10264, 10371
10455
10037
10217
10093, 10864, 11944
10009, 10208, 10455, 10805
10009, 10037, 10218, 10556
10178, 10009, 10374
10000
10218, 10287, 10335
10009
10054
10748, 10587, 10865, 10870,
10871, 10872
10455
10880, 11504
10217
10047, 10054, 10154, 10000,
10051, 10178, 10030, 10171,
10092, 10036, 10037, 10876,
11271, 11904, 11944
10000, 10180, 10178, 10171,
11904, 11944
10000, 10451, 10093, 10060,
10178, 10092, 10036
11144, 11240, 11331
10037
10447
10178, 10092, 10009
10009
10009, 10374, 10817
10109, 10361, 10367
10093, 10163, 10217, 10218
11371
10092, 10036, 10163, 10170,
10217, 10650
10054, 10154, 10000, 10156,
10051, 10060, 10037, 10036,
10011, 10009, 10217, 11156,
11191, 11248, 11254, 11371,
11556, 11756
10706, 10698, 11027, 11537
10714, 10808
10154, 10178, 10171, 10706,
11755, 11149, 11037, 10714,
10712, 10698, 10668, 10512,
10455, 10418, 10264, 10217,
10170, 10037, 10009
10009, 10037, 10163, 10217,
10335
10037, 10668, 11163
10218
11982
Technics
TechniSat
Technisson
Technosonic
Technovox
Techview
Techwood
Tecnimagen
Teco
Tedelex
Teiron
Tek
Teknika
Tele System
Electronic
Teleavia
Telecolor
Telecor
Telefunken
Telefusion
Telegazi
Telemeister
Telesonic
Telestar
Teletech
Teleton
Televideon
Teleview
Tempest
Tennessee
Tensai
Tenson
Tera
Tevion
Texet
Texla
ThemeScene
Thomas
Thomson
Thorn
Thorn-Ferguson
10054, 10250, 10051, 10226,
10556, 10650
10556, 11267
10714
10499, 10556
10030, 10217
10847
10250, 10051, 10060, 11163
10556
10051, 10093, 10178, 10092,
10009, 10036, 10218, 10264,
10653, 11040
10009, 10208, 10217, 10418,
10606, 10698, 11537
10009
10820
10054, 10463, 10180, 10150,
10060, 10178, 10092
Tiane
Tiny
TMK
TML
TNCi
Tobishi
Tobo
Tocom
Tokai
Tokaido
Tokyo
Tomashi
Tongguang
Tongtel
Topline
10876
10287, 10343
10017
10037, 10163, 10217, 10218,
10394
10702, 11504, 10821, 10820,
10819, 10714, 10712, 10698,
10625, 10587, 10560, 10498,
10486, 10346, 10343, 10335,
10287, 10109, 10074, 10073,
10037
10037
10037, 10163, 10218, 10264
10037
10037
10009, 10037, 10556
10009, 10037, 10668, 11037
10036, 10217
10163
10037
10009, 10264, 10455
10037
10009, 10037, 10217, 10218,
10371, 10374, 10715, 11037
10009
10030, 10092
10037, 10556, 10648, 10668,
10714, 10808, 11037, 11137,
11248, 11298, 11498, 11556
10009, 10217, 10218, 10374
10780
10887
10047, 10178, 10001, 11904
11447, 10047, 10037, 10109,
10287, 10335, 10343, 10560,
10625
10035, 10036, 10037, 10073,
10074, 10109, 10163, 10264,
10335, 10343, 10361, 10499,
10512
10073, 10335, 10343, 10499
Toshiba
Totevision
Towada
Toyoda
Toyomenka
Trakton
Trans Continens
TRANS-continents
Transonic
Triad
Trident
Trio
Tristar
Triumph
Truetone
Tuntex
TVS
TVTEXT 95
U
Uher
Ultra
Ultravox
Unic Line
United
Universal
Universum
10093, 10817
11269
10236, 10180, 10178
11756
10017
10218
10748, 10009, 10264
10156
10009, 10037, 10163, 10217,
10374, 10668, 11037
11037
10035
10218
10264
10587, 10780
10668, 11037
10154, 11256, 10156, 10150,
11265, 10060, 11145, 10145,
10166, 11037, 11156, 11163,
11164, 11356, 11508, 11556,
11656, 11704, 11945, 11971,
10845, 10821, 10718, 10650,
10618, 10508, 10264, 10217,
10195, 10109, 10070, 10036,
10035, 10011, 10009
10051
10217
10009, 10264, 10371
10178
10217, 10264
10037, 10217, 10668, 11037
10556, 10865
10009, 10037, 10264, 10418,
10455, 10512, 10587, 10698,
10712, 10780
10218, 10556
10217
11498
10218, 10264
10037, 10346, 10556
10250, 10051
10030, 10092, 10009
10463
10556
10037, 10370, 10374, 10418,
10480, 10486
10092
10037, 10163, 10374
10037, 10455
10037, 10587, 10714, 10715,
11037, 11982
10047, 10037
11163, 11037, 10668, 10631,
10618, 10512, 10480, 10418,
10370, 10362, 10361, 10346,
10327, 10264, 10217, 10200,
10195, 10170, 10109, 10074,
10070, 10037, 10036, 10011,
10009
V
Univox
V
V2max
V7 Videoseven
Vector Research
Vestel
Vexa
Victor
Videocon
Videologic
Videologique
Videomac
VideoSystem
Videotechnic
Videoton
Vidikron
Vidtech
Viewpia
Viewsonic
Viking
Viore
Vision
Vizio
Vortec
Voxson
W
Waltham
Wards
Warumaia
Watson
Watt Radio
Waycon
Wega
Wegavox
Weipai
Welltech
Weltblick
Welton
Weltstar
Westinghouse
Wharfedale
White
Westinghouse
Windsor
Windy Sam
Wintel
World
10037, 10163
10864, 10885, 11755, 11756
10865
10880, 11217, 11755
10030
10037, 10217, 10668, 11037,
11163
10009, 10037
10250, 10053, 10036, 10650,
10653
10508
10218
10217, 10218
10009
10037
10217, 10374
10163
10054
10178, 10036
10876
10857, 10864, 10885, 11330,
11578, 11627, 11755
10060
11207
10037, 10217, 10264
10864, 10885, 11755, 11756,
11758
10037
10178, 10037, 10163, 10418
10037, 10109, 10217, 10418,
10443, 10668, 11037
10047, 10054, 10017, 10154,
10000, 10156, 10051, 10093,
10236, 10180, 10060, 10178,
10030, 10166, 11347, 11156,
11147, 10866, 10195, 10001,
10037, 10035
10374, 10661
10009, 10037, 10163, 10218,
10394, 10668, 10714, 11037
10163
10156
10036, 10037
10009
10009
10714
10217
10178
11037
10000, 10451, 10885, 10889,
11282, 11577
10037, 10556, 10860, 11556
10451, 10236, 10463, 10037,
10623, 10889, 11909
10668, 11037
10556
10714
10451, 10236, 10463, 10180
World-of-Vision
X
Worldview
X-View
Xenius
Xiahua
Y
Xianghai
Xiangyang
Xiangyu
Xihu
Xingfu
Xinghai
XLogic
Xoceco
Xoro
XR-1000
Xrypton
Yamaha
Yamishi
Yapshe
Yingge
Yokan
Yoko
Z
Yonggu
Yorx
Youlanasi
Yousida
Yuhang
Zanussi
Zenith
ZhuHai
10865, 10877, 10880, 11217,
11298
10455
11191
10634, 10661
10009, 10264, 10698, 10773,
10817
10009
10264
10009
10264, 10817
10009
10264
10698, 10860
11064
11196, 11217
10154, 10180, 10171
10037
10030, 10650, 11576
10037, 10217, 10218, 10455
10250
10009
10037
10009, 10037, 10217, 10218,
10264, 10370
10009
10030, 10218
10817
10009
10009
10163, 10217, 10264
10047, 10017, 10000, 10093,
10463, 11265, 10812, 10178,
10030, 11145, 10145, 10171,
10092, 10037, 11904, 11909,
11911
10009, 10374
TV/DVD Combination b2, b4
b2
A
B
C
D
Advent
Akai
Akura
Alba
Amstrad
Apex Digital
Audiovox
Axion
Black Diamond
Bush
Centrum
Crown
D-Vision
Denver
11933
11675
11982
11037
11982
11943
11937, 11951, 11952
11937, 11958
11037
10698, 11037, 11900
11037
11037
11982
10587
PRESET CODE
8.AVR2808E2_PresetBack.indd
9
2007/09/28
12:59:25
E
F
G
H
J
K
L
M
N
P
R
S
T
U
V
Elfunk
Ferguson
Finlux
Goodmans
Hitachi
JDV
Jensen
KLH
Lenco
Logik
Luker
Luxor
Matsui
Maxim
Medion
Mirror
Naiko
Narita
Panasonic
Philips
Powerpoint
Prima
RCA
Roadstar
Saivod
Samsung
Schneider
SEG
Sova
Stevison
Sylvania
Teac
Technica
Telefunken
Thomson
Transonic
United
Vestel
11037
11037
11556
10587, 11037, 11900
11960
11982
11933
11962
10587
11037
11982
11037
11037
11982
11900
11900
11982
11982
11941
11454, 10556, 11961
10698
11933
11948, 11958
11900
11982
11903
11982
11037
11952
11982
10171
10698
11982
10698
10625
10587
10587, 11037, 11982
11037
b4
A
B
C
D
10
Akai
Akura
Alba
Amstrad
Apex Digital
Black Diamond
Broksonic
Bush
Centrum
Citizen
Crown
D-Vision
30695
31367
30695, 30884
31367
30830
30713, 30884
30695
30713, 30884
30713
30695
30713
31367
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
N
O
P
R
S
T
U
V
DMTech
Elfunk
Emerson
ESA
Ferguson
Funai
Goodmans
Grandin
Grundig
Hitachi
Insignia
JDV
JNC
Konka
Logik
Luker
Luxor
Magnavox
Matsui
Maxim
Naiko
Narita
Neovia
Orion
Pacific
Panasonic
Philips
RCA
Saivod
Samsung
Sansui
Schneider
SEG
Sliding
Stevison
Sylvania
Technica
Thomson
Toshiba
United
Universum
Vestel
31271
30713, 30884
30675, 31268
31268
30695, 30713, 30884
31268
30713
30713
30539, 30695
31247
31268
31367
31271
31192
30713, 30884
31367
30713
31268
30713, 30884
31367
31367
31367
31271
30695
30695
31490
30539, 30854, 31260
31022
31367
30899
30695
31367
30713, 30884
31115
31367
30630, 30675, 31268
31367
30551
30695
30713, 30884, 31367
30713
30884
C
D
E
F
Broksonic
Bush
Curtis Mathes
Daewoo
Emerson
Ferguson
Fidelity
Funai
G
GE
H
I
J
L
M
O
P
Q
R
RCA
S
T
TV/VCR Combination b2, b3, b4
b2
A
B
Aiwa
America Action
Amstrad
Audiovox
Beko
Black Diamond
11904, 11911
10180
10171
10180
10486
11909
GoldStar
Goodmans
Grundig
Harley Davidson
Hinari
Hitachi
Internal
JVC
LG
Lloyd’s
Magnavox
Memorex
Mitsubishi
Orion
Palsonic
Panasonic
Penney
Philips
Quasar
Radiola
RadioShack
W
Z
Saba
Samsung
Sansui
Schneider
Sears
Sharp
Siemens
Sony
Sylvania
Symphonic
Teac
Technics
Thomas
Thomson
Toshiba
White
Westinghouse
Zenith
10463, 11911
11556
10051
11909
10236, 10463, 11909, 11911
10073, 10625
10171
11904
10047, 10051, 10093, 11917,
11922
10037
10374, 11909
10037, 10195, 10556
11904
10036
11904
11909
11923
10178
11904
10054, 11904
10250
10093, 10556, 11917
10463, 11911
11904
10250, 10051
10051
10037, 10556
10250, 10051
10556
11904
10047, 10051, 10093, 11917,
11922
10625
11959
10463, 11904, 11911
10037, 10556, 11904
11904
10093, 11917
10037
10000, 11505, 11904
10054
11904
10178, 10171
10556
11904
10625
11971
11909
11904, 11909, 11911
b3
A
Aiwa
20000, 20352, 20479, 20742,
21137
B
C
D
Akai
Alba
America Action
Amstrad
Audiovox
Beko
Bestar
Blue Sky
BPL
Broksonic
Bush
Citizen
Curtis Mathes
Daewoo
Dantax
E
F
Emerson
G
GE
H
I
J
K
L
M
Ferguson
Fidelity
Firstline
Funai
GoldStar
Goodmans
Grandin
Grundig
Hanimex
Harley Davidson
Hinari
Hitachi
Hypson
Internal
JBL
JMB
Kambrook
Kneissel
LG
Lloyd’s
Loewe
Magnasonic
Magnavox
Magnin
Matsui
Medion
Memorex
O
MGA
Mitsubishi
Optimus
Orion
P
Pace
Pacific
20352
20352
20278
20000
20278
20104
20278
20278, 20352, 20742
20046
20002, 20479, 21479
20352, 20742
20278, 21278
20035, 21035
20278, 20637, 21278
20352
20002, 20278, 20479, 20637,
21278, 21479
20000, 20278
20000
20278
20000
20060, 20035, 20048, 20240,
20807, 21035, 21060
20037, 20480, 21237
20278, 20352, 20637
20278, 20742
20081, 20347, 20352, 20742
20352
20000
20352
20000
20037
20278, 20637
20278
20352
20037
20278, 20352
20037, 20480, 21237
20000
20037
20278, 21278
20081, 20000, 21781
20240
20352, 20742
20352
20162, 20037, 21162, 21237,
21262
20240
20048, 20081, 20043, 20807
20162, 21162, 21262
20002, 20352, 20479, 20742,
21479
20352
20742
Palsonic
Panasonic
Penney
Q
R
Philips
Portland
Quasar
Radiola
RadioShack
RCA
S
T
U
W
Z
Saba
Samsung
Sansui
Sanyo
Saville
Schneider
Sears
SEG
Sharp
Shivaki
Siemens
Sinudyne
Sony
Supra
Sylvania
Symphonic
Tatung
Teac
Technics
Technosonic
Telefunken
Thomas
Thomson
Toshiba
United
White
Westinghouse
Zenith
20000
20035, 20162, 21035, 21162,
21262
20035, 20037, 20240, 21035,
21237
20081
20637
20035, 20162, 21035, 21162
20081
20000
20060, 20035, 20048, 20240,
20807, 21035, 21060
20320
20240, 20432, 21014
20000, 20479, 21479
20240
20352
20081, 20000
20037, 20000, 21237
20637
20037, 20048, 20807
20037
20081
20352
20032, 20000, 21232
20348
20081, 21781
20000
20352
20037, 20000, 20637, 20642
20081
20352
20278
20000
20278
20352, 20432, 20845, 21145
20742
20278, 20637
20000, 20479, 20637, 21479
b4
T
Thomson
30551
TV/VCR/DVD Combination
b2, b3, b4
b2
A
B
E
M
P
R
Akai
Broksonic
Emerson
ESA
Magnavox
Panasonic
RCA
11903
11938
11944
11944
11944
11946, 11947
11953
PRESET CODE
8.AVR2808E2_PresetBack.indd
10
2007/09/28
12:59:27
S
T
Sharp
Sylvania
Symphonic
Toshiba
11917
11944
11944
11945
b3
S
Sharp
20807
Akai
Emerson
ESA
Magnavox
Panasonic
RCA
Sharp
Superscan
Sylvania
Symphonic
Toshiba
30899
30821
30821
30821
31362, 31462
31132
30630
30821
30821
30821
31045
b4
A
E
M
P
R
S
T
B
VCR
A
20037, 20240, 20000, 20278,
20046
21972
20060, 20048, 20039, 20047,
20104, 20121, 20209, 20479
20037, 20240, 20000
20278
20278, 20348, 20642
20037, 20032, 20000, 20209,
20041, 20348, 20352, 20479,
20742, 21137
20037, 20240, 20041, 20106,
20315, 20348, 20352, 20642
20041
20081, 20000, 20209, 20278,
20315, 20348, 20352
21972
20039, 21137
20240
20081
20278
20035, 20081
20479
20000, 20278
20162, 20037, 20240, 20278,
20226, 20480
20162, 20226, 21162, 21562
20000
20081
20037, 20081
20240
20035, 20240
20037, 20081, 20000, 20038
A-Mark
ABS
Admiral
Adventura
Aiko
Aim
Aiwa
Akai
Akura
Alba
Alienware
Allegro
Allorgan
Allstar
America Action
American High
Amoisonic
Amstrad
Anam
Anam National
Ansonic
Aristona
ASA
Asha
Astra
Asuka
C
20081
20278
20037, 20278, 20038
20000
20000, 20352
20037, 20043, 20278, 20642
20000, 20104, 20041, 20278,
Baird
20046, 20106
Basic Line
20104, 20278, 20046
Beaumark
20240
Beko
20104
20035, 20048, 20039, 20000,
Bell & Howell
20104, 20046, 20479
Bestar
20278
Black Diamond
20642
Black Panther
20278
Blaupunkt
20162, 20081, 20226
20037, 20209, 20278, 20348,
Blue Sky
20352, 20480, 20642, 20742,
21137
BPL
20046
Brandt
20041, 20320
Brandt Electronique 20041
Brinkmann
20209, 20348
20184, 20121, 20209, 20002,
Broksonic
20348, 20479, 21479
20081, 20000, 20209, 20278,
Bush
20315, 20348, 20352, 20642,
20742
Calix
20037
Candle
20037, 20038
Canon
20035
Capehart
20002
Carena
20081, 20209
Carrefour
20045
Carrera
20240
Carver
20035, 20081
Casio
20000
Cathay
20278
CCE
20278
CGE
20000, 20041
Changhong
20048, 20081
Cimline
20209
Cineral
20278
CineVision
21137
20035, 20037, 20240, 20000,
Citizen
20209, 20278, 20479, 21278
Classic
20037
Clatronic
20000, 21593
Colortyme
20060, 20035, 20045, 20278
Colt
20000
Combitech
20352
Condor
20278
Craig
20037, 20047, 20240
Criterion
20000
Crosley
Crown
Audiolab
Audiosonic
Audiovox
Avis
AVP
Awa
Curtis Mathes
Cybernex
CyberPower
Cyrus
D
Daewoo
Dansai
Dantax
Daytron
De Graaf
Decca
Degraff
Deitron
Dell
Denon
Derwent
Diamant
Diamond
Digitor
DirecTV
Domland
DSE
Dual
E
Dumont
Durabrand
Dynatech
Elbe
Electrohome
Electrophonic
Elin
Elta
Emerald
Emerex
Emerson
ESA
ESC
EuroLine
F
Ferguson
Fidelity
Finlandia
Finlux
20035, 20081, 20000
20037, 20278, 20480
20060, 20035, 20162, 20240,
20000, 20041, 20278, 20432,
21035
20240
21972
20081
20037, 20045, 20104, 20209,
20278, 20046, 20352, 20637,
20642, 21137, 21278
20278
20352
20037, 20278
20048, 20081, 20042, 20104,
20046
20081, 20000, 20067, 20209,
20041, 20352
20048, 20081, 20042, 20104
20278
21972
20081, 20042
20041
20037
20348
20642
20739
20209
20642
20081, 20000, 20041, 20278,
20348
20081, 20000, 20104
20039, 20038, 20642
20240, 20000
20278, 20038
20060, 20037, 20240, 20000,
20043, 20209
20037
20240
20278
20184, 20121
20032
20035, 20037, 20184, 20039,
20240, 20045, 20000, 20121,
20043, 20209, 20002, 20278,
20348, 20479, 20637, 21278,
21479, 21593
21137
20240, 20278
21593
20000, 20041, 20278, 20320,
20348
20240, 20000, 20352, 20432
20037, 20048, 20081, 20000,
20042, 20104, 20043, 20046,
20106, 20226
20081, 20000, 20042, 20104
Firstline
Fisher
G
Flint
Fuji
Fujitsu
Fujitsu General
Funai
Galaxi
Galaxis
Garrard
Gateway
GE
GEC
Gemini
General
General Technic
Genexxa
Go Video
GoldStar
Goodmans
GPX
Gradiente
Graetz
Granada
Grandin
Grundig
H
Haaz
Hanimex
Hanseatic
Haojie
Harley Davidson
Harman/Kardon
Headquarter
Hewlett Packard
HI-Q
Hinari
Hisawa
Hischito
Hitachi
Hoeher
Hornyphon
Howard Computers
HP
20037, 20045, 20042, 20043,
20209, 20278, 20348, 20480,
21137
20039, 20047, 20000, 20104,
20046
20209, 20348
20035, 20033
20037, 20045, 20000
20037
20037, 20000, 20278, 21593
20000
20278
20000
21972
20060, 20035, 20048, 20240,
20000, 20226, 20320, 20807,
21035, 21060
20081
20060
20045
20348
20037, 20000, 20104, 20278
20240, 20432, 20614, 21137
20035, 20037, 20039, 20000,
20209, 20278, 20038, 20225,
20226, 20480, 21137, 21237
20037, 20081, 20240, 20000,
20209, 20278, 20348, 20352,
20637, 20642, 20742
20037
20000
20240, 20104, 20041
20035, 20037, 20048, 20081,
20240, 20000, 20042, 20104,
20046, 20226
20037, 20000, 20209, 20278,
20742
20081, 20226, 20320, 20347,
20348, 20352, 20742
20348
20352
20037, 20081, 20209, 20038
20240
20000
20081, 20038
20046
21972
20035, 20047, 20000
20240, 20209, 20041, 20278,
20352
20209, 2035
20045
20035, 20037, 20081, 20240,
20045, 20000, 20042, 20041,
20046, 20089
20278, 20642
20081
21972
21972
Hughes Network
Systems
Humax
Hush
Hypson
I
Hytek
iBUYPOWER
Imperial
Ingersol
Interbuy
Interfunk
Internal
International
Intervision
Irradio
ITT
J
ITT Nokia
ITV
Janeil
JBL
Jensen
JMB
Joyce
JVC
K
Kambrook
Karcher
KEC
Kendo
Kenwood
KIC
Kimari
Kneissel
L
Kodak
Kolin
Kolster
KTV
Kuba
Kuba Electronic
Lenco
LG
Lifetec
Linksys
Lloyd’s
Loewe
Logik
Lumatron
Lunatron
20042, 20739
20739
21972
20037, 20000, 20209, 20278,
20352, 20480
20047, 20000
21972
20000
20240, 20209
20037
20081, 20104
20278, 20637
20037, 20278, 20642
20037, 20000, 20209, 20278,
20348
20037, 20081, 21137
20240, 20104, 20041, 20046,
20106
20240, 20104, 20041, 20106
20037, 20278
20240
20278
20067, 20041
20209, 20348, 20352, 20742
20000
20184, 20081, 20045, 20067,
20041, 21162
20037
20081, 20278, 20642
20037, 20278
20037, 20209, 20278, 20106,
20315, 20348, 20642
20067, 20041, 20038, 20046
20000
20047
20037, 20209, 20278, 20348,
20352
20035, 20037
20043, 20041
20209
20000
20047
20047
20278
20037, 20240, 20045, 20000,
20042, 20209, 20278, 20038,
20225, 20480, 21137, 21237
20209, 20348
21972
20240, 20000, 20038
21062, 20162, 20037, 20081,
21262, 21562
20240, 20000, 20209, 20106
20278, 21137
21137
PRESET CODE
8.AVR2808E2_PresetBack.indd
11
11
2007/09/28
12:59:28
20048, 20047, 20104, 20043,
20046, 20106, 20315
20037, 20000, 20042, 20067
20037, 20240, 20000, 20038
20081
20037, 20240, 20000, 20278,
21278
20035, 20037, 20048, 20039,
20081, 20240, 20000, 20226,
20618, 20642, 21593, 21781
20240
20642
20081, 20045, 20209
20035, 20081, 20209, 20038
20000, 20278
20037
20642
20278
20037, 20240, 20209, 20278,
20348, 20352, 20742
20035, 20162, 20081, 20226,
21162
21972
20081
20209, 20348, 20352, 20642
20035
20035, 20162, 20037, 20048,
20039, 20047, 20240, 20000,
20104, 20209, 20278, 20046,
20348, 20479, 21162, 21237,
21262
20081
21062, 20162, 20037, 20081,
20226, 20347, 20836, 21162,
21262, 21562
20060, 20240, 20043
20240
20348
20209
21972
20240
20000
21972
20042
20060, 20048, 20047, 20081,
20000, 20042, 20067, 20043,
20041, 20480, 20642, 20807
20035, 20048
20240, 20000
20000
20037
20039, 20000
20000
20081
20240, 20104
20348, 20642
20039
20226
Luxor
M
LXI
M Electronic
Magnadyne
Magnasonic
Magnavox
Magnin
Magnum
Manesth
Marantz
Mark
Marta
Mastec
Master’s
Matsui
Matsushita
Media Center PC
Mediator
Medion
MEI
Memorex
Metronic
Metz
MGA
MGN Technology
Micormay
Micromaxx
Microsoft
Midland
Migros
Mind
Minolta
Mitsubishi
N
12
Motorola
MTC
MTX
Multitec
Multitech
Murphy
Myryad
NAD
Naiko
NAP
National
Nebula Electronics
NEC
Neckermann
Nesco
Neufunk
Newave
Nikkai
Nikko
Nikkodo
Nishi
Niveus Media
Noblex
Nokia
Nordmende
Northgate
Nu-Tec
O
Oceanic
Okano
Olympus
Onimax
Onkyo
Optimus
Orion
P
Orson
Osaki
Otake
Otto Versand
Pace
Pacific
Packard Bell
Palladium
Palsonic
Panama
Panasonic
Pathe Cinema
Pathe Marconi
Penney
Pentax
Perdio
Philco
20033
20035, 20037, 20048, 20104,
20067, 20041, 20278, 20038,
21137
20081, 20041
20000
20209
20037
20278
20037, 20278
20037, 20278
20240
21972
20240
20048, 20081, 20240, 20042,
20104, 20041, 20278, 20046,
20106, 20315
20067, 20041, 20320
21972
20209
20048, 20081, 20000, 20104,
20041, 20046, 20106
20209, 20278, 20315, 20348
20035, 20162, 20104, 20226
20642
20222
21062, 20035, 20162, 20037,
20048, 20047, 20240, 20000,
20104, 20432, 21162, 21262
20184, 20240, 20000, 20104,
20121, 20209, 20002, 20278,
20348, 20352, 20479, 20742,
21479
20000
20037, 20000
20209
20081
20352
20000, 20348, 20642, 20742
21972
20037, 20209, 20041, 20348
20000, 20642
20035
21062, 20035, 20162, 20000,
20225, 20226, 20614, 20616,
20836, 21035, 21162, 21262,
21562
20043
20041
20035, 20162, 20037, 20047,
20081, 20240, 20000, 20042,
20067, 20038, 21035, 21237
20042
20000, 20209
20035, 20081, 20000, 20209,
20038, 20226, 20479
Philips
Q
Phoenix
Phonola
Pilot
Pioneer
Polk Audio
Portland
Presidian
Prinz
Profitronic
Proline
Proscan
Prosco
Prosonic
Protec
Protech
ProVision
Pulsar
Pulser
Pye
Qisheng
Quarter
Quartz
Quasar
R
Quelle
Radialva
Radiola
Radionette
RadioShack
Radix
Randex
Rank
Rank Arena
RCA
Realistic
Reoc
ReplayTV
Rex
Ricavision
Rio
Roadstar
S
Runco
Saba
Saisho
Salora
20035, 20162, 20048, 20081,
20045, 20000, 20209, 20226,
20616, 20618, 20739, 21081,
21181
20278
20081
20037
20162, 20081, 20042, 20067
20081
20278, 20637
21593
20000
20081, 20240
20000, 20278, 20320, 20642
20060, 21060
20278
20209, 20278
20000
20081
20278
20039, 20240, 20278
20240
20081, 20000
20060
20046
20035, 20047, 20046
20035, 20162, 20002, 20278,
20226, 21035, 21162
20081
20037, 20048, 20081
20081
20037, 21137
20035, 20162, 20037, 20048,
20047, 20240, 20000, 20104,
20046, 21162
20037
20037
20041
20041
20060, 20035, 20048, 20240,
20045, 20000, 20042, 20106,
20226, 20320, 20807, 20880,
21035, 21060
20035, 20162, 20037, 20048,
20047, 20240, 20000, 20104,
20121, 20278, 20046, 21162
20348
20614, 20616
20041
21972
21137
20037, 20081, 20240, 20278,
20038, 20742
20039
20041, 20278, 20320
20209, 20348
20104, 20043, 20046, 20106
Sampo
Samsung
Samtron
Sanky
Sansei
Sansui
Sanyo
Saville
SBR
ScanSonic
Schaub Lorenz
Schneider
Scott
Sears
Seaway
SEG
SEI
Sei-Sinudyne
Seleco
Semp
Sentra
Sharp
Shinco
Shintom
Shivaki
Shogun
Siemens
Siera
Signature
Silva
Silver
SilverCrest
Singer
Sinudyne
Smaragd
Sonic Blue
Sonographe
Sonolor
Sontec
Sonwa
Sony
20037, 20048
20060, 20240, 20045, 20000,
20038, 20432, 20739, 21014
20240
20048, 20039
20048
20240, 20000, 20067, 20209,
20041, 20002, 20106, 20348,
20479, 21479
20048, 20047, 20240, 20000,
20104, 20067, 20209, 20046,
20348, 20479, 21137
20240, 20278, 20352
20081
20240
20000, 20104, 20041, 20106,
20315, 20348
20037, 20081, 20240, 20000,
20042, 20278, 20348, 20352,
20642, 21137
20184, 20045, 20121, 20043
20060, 20035, 20162, 20037,
20048, 20039, 20047, 20033,
20045, 20000, 20042, 20104,
20067, 20043, 20209, 20041,
21237, 20046
20278
20081, 20240, 20278, 20637,
20642
20081
20081
20037, 20041
20045
20278
20037, 20048, 20047, 20032,
20000, 20209, 20807
20000
20039, 20240, 20000, 20104
20037
20240
20037, 20081, 20104, 20046,
20320, 20347
20081
20060, 20035, 20037, 20048,
20000, 20046, 20479
20037
20278
20642
20037, 20240, 20045, 20348
20081, 20209, 20352
20348
20614, 20616, 21137
20046
20048, 20046
20037, 20278
20642
20035, 20048, 20047, 20032,
20033, 20000, 20067, 20046,
20106, 20226, 20636, 21232,
21972
Soundmaster
Soundwave
Stack 9
Standard
Stern
STS
Sunkai
Sunstar
Suntronic
Supra
Susumu
SV2000
SVA
Sylvania
T
Symphonic
Systemax
T+A
Tagar Systems
Taisho
Tandberg
Tandy
Tashiko
Tatung
Tchibo
TCM
Teac
Technics
TechniSat
Technosonic
Teco
Tedelex
Teknika
Teleavia
Telecorder
Telefunken
Telerent
Telestar
Teletech
Tensai
Tevion
Texet
Thomas
Thomson
Thorn
Tisonic
Tivo
TMK
20000
20037, 20209, 20348
21972
20278
20278
20042
20209, 20278, 20348
20000
20000
20037, 20278, 20348
20037
20000
20000
20035, 20081, 20000, 20043,
21593, 21781
20240, 20000, 20002, 21593
21972
20162
21972
20209
20278
20000, 20104
20037, 20048, 20081, 20240,
20000
20048, 20081, 20045, 20000,
20067, 20043, 20209, 20041,
20348, 20352
20348
20348
20037, 20000, 20067, 20041,
20278, 20637, 20642, 21593
20035, 20162, 20037, 20081,
20000, 20226, 21162
20348
20352
20035, 20037, 20048, 20041,
20038
20037, 20209, 20348, 20642
20035, 20037, 20000
20041
20240
20209, 20041, 20278, 20320,
20642
20226
20037
20000, 20278
20037, 20000, 20278
20209, 20348, 20479, 20642
20278
20000, 20002
20060, 20067, 20041, 20278,
20320
20037, 20104, 20041, 20320
20278
20618, 20636, 20739, 21996
20240, 20000
PRESET CODE
8.AVR2808E2_PresetBack.indd
12
2007/09/28
12:59:30
TNIX
Tocom
Tokai
Topline
20037
20240
20037, 20104, 20041
20348
20081, 20240, 20045, 20000,
20042, 20067, 20043, 20209,
20041, 20352, 20432, 20742,
20845, 21008, 21145, 21972,
21996
20278
20037, 20240
21972
20278
20081
20278
20037
20240
20045, 20278
20278
20240
20348, 20742, 21593
20037, 20081, 20240, 20000,
20104, 20209, 20106, 20348,
21137
20045
20184, 20038
20067, 20041
20045
20000
20037
20240, 20000
21972
20000
21972
20060, 20035, 20037, 20048,
20039, 20047, 20081, 20033,
20240, 20045, 20000, 20042,
20043, 20041, 20038, 20046,
20479
20081, 20352, 20642
20037
20642
20000, 20209, 20278, 20479,
20637
20209, 20002, 20348, 20479
20035, 20240, 20000
20041, 20038
20278
20037, 20240
20037, 20039, 20033, 20000,
20209, 20041, 20278, 20479,
20637, 21137, 21479
21972
20209, 20348, 20352
Toshiba
U
Tosonic
Totevision
Touch
Toyoda
Tradex
Triad
Trix
Uher
Ultra
Ultravox
Unitech
United
Universum
V
W
X
Y
Z
Vector
Vector Research
Victor
Video Concepts
Video Technic
Videomagic
Videosonic
Viewsonic
Villain
Voodoo
Wards
Watson
Weltblick
Wharfedale
White
Westinghouse
World
XR-1000
Yamaha
Yamishi
Yoko
Zenith
ZT Group
ZX
PVR b3
A
C
D
G
H
I
L
M
N
P
R
S
T
V
Z
ABS
Alienware
CyberPower
Dell
DirecTV
Gateway
Go Video
Hewlett Packard
Howard Computers
HP
Hughes Network
Systems
Humax
Hush
iBUYPOWER
Linksys
Media Center PC
Microsoft
Mind
Niveus Media
Northgate
Panasonic
Philips
RCA
ReplayTV
Samsung
Sonic Blue
Sony
Stack 9
Systemax
Tagar Systems
Tivo
Toshiba
Touch
Viewsonic
Voodoo
ZT Group
21972
21972
21972
21972
20739
21972
20614
21972
21972
21972
A
3D LAB
4Kus
A-Trend
Acoustic Solutions
AEG
AFK
Aim
Airis
Aiwa
Akashi
AKI
Akira
Akura
Alba
Alco
Alize
All-Tel
Allegro
Altacom
Amitech
Amoi
Amphion Media
Works
Amstrad
AMW
Anam
Ansonic
20739
20739
21972
21972
21972
21972
21972
21972
21972
21972
20614, 20616
20618, 20739
20880
20614, 20616
20739
20614, 20616
20636, 21972
21972
21972
21972
20618, 20636, 20739
21008, 21972, 21996
21972
21972
21972
21972
DVD Player
1
Akai
30503, 30539
31158
30714
30713, 30730, 31228
30770, 30788, 30790, 31923
31051, 31152, 31923
30672, 30699, 30833
30672, 31005, 31224, 31250,
31321, 31345
30533, 30641
Apex Digital
B
Aristona
Arrgo
ASCOMTEC
Asono
Aspire Digital
Atacom
Audiosonic
Audiovox
Audioworld
Autovox
Auvio
Awa
Axion
Base
Basic Line
Baze
BBK
Beep
Bellagio
Belson
Binatone
Black Diamond
Blaupunkt
Blu:sens
Blue Nova
International
Blue Parade
30690, 30695, 30705, 30770,
30788, 30790, 30884, 30898,
30899, 31115, 31205, 31233,
31695
30838
31005
30699, 31321
30898, 31051, 31140, 31233,
31367
30672, 30539, 30717, 30695,
30699, 30713, 30730, 30783,
30884, 31140, 31530, 31695
30790
31151
31451
30869
31224
30784, 30770, 30850
30852
C
30872
30713, 30770, 31151, 31367
30872
31913
30759, 30774, 30831
30533, 30672, 30717, 30755,
30794, 30796, 30797, 30830,
31004, 31020, 31056, 31061
30539, 30646
31023
31923
31224
31168
31224
30690, 31923
30717, 30790
30790
30713
30843
30730, 30872
30730
31451
30713
30898
30862, 31224
31163
31004
31086, 31923
31923
30713, 30833, 30884
30717
31233, 31321
31321
30571
30672, 30651, 30695, 30699,
30713, 30790, 30843, 31423
Boghe
31004
Boman
30783, 30898, 31005
Bose
32023
Brainwave
30770, 31115
Brandt
30503, 30651, 30551
Broksonic
30695
30672, 30717, 30690, 30699,
30713, 30723, 30730, 30831,
Bush
30833, 30884, 31051, 31140,
31483, 31695, 31832
Byd:sign
30872
C-Tech
30798, 31152
California Audio Labs 30490
Cambridge Audio
30751, 31109
Cambridge
30690
Soundworks
Campomatic Digital 31051
Cat
30699, 30789, 31421, 31923
CCE
30730
Celestial
31020
cello
31730
Centrex
30672, 31004
30713, 30789, 31005, 31227,
Centrum
31923
CGV
30751, 31115
Changhong
30627, 31061
Cinea
30831, 30841
Cinetec
30713, 30872
cineULTRA
30699
CineVision
30833, 30869, 31483
Citizen
30695
Clairtone
30571
Classic
30730, 31730
Clatronic
30672, 30675, 30788, 31233
Clayton
30713
30730, 30852, 31086, 31321,
Coby
31923
Codex
31233
Commax
31321
Conia
30672, 30852, 31321
Contel
30788
Continental Edison 30831, 30872
Craig
30831
Creative
30503, 30539
Crown
30690, 30713, 30770, 31115
Crypto
31228
Curtis Mathes
31087
Cybercom
30831
30714, 30816, 30874, 31023,
CyberHome
31024, 31117, 31129, 31502
Cytron
30651, 30705, 30774, 31347
D-Vision
31115, 31367
Daenyx
30872
Blue Sky
D
Daewoo
Dalton
Dansai
Dantax
Daytek
Dayton
DCE
Decca
Denon
Denver
Denzel
Desay
Dgtec
Diamond
Digihome
DigiLogic
digiRED
Digitech
Digitor
Digitrex
DiK
Dinamic
Disney
DiViDo
DK Digital
DMTech
Dragon
DreamX
DSE
Dual
E
Durabrand
DVD2000
DVX
E:max
EagleTec
eBench
ECC
Eclipse
Elfunk
Elin
Elite
Ellion
Elta
Eltax
Emerson
Enterprise
30490, 30784, 30705, 30714,
30770, 30833, 30869, 30872,
31172, 31483, 31906
31036
30770, 30783, 31115, 31695
30539, 30713, 30723, 30790
30872, 31005
30872
30831
30770, 31115
30490, 30634, 31634,
[32134]z
30672, 30699, 30788, 30898,
31056, 31104, 31321, 31923
30665
30843, 31212
30672
30651, 30751, 30768, 30790
30713
30713
30717
31832
30651, 30690, 30833, 31005,
31423
30672, 31004, 31056
30831
30788
30675, 30831, 31270
30705
30831
30783, 31271
30831
31151
30833, 31152, 31730
30651, 30665, 30675, 30713,
30730, 30783, 30790, 30831,
31023
30713, 30831, 31023, 31502
30521
30768
31233, 31321
30714
31152
30730
30723, 30751
30713, 30850, 30884
30770
31152
30850, 31421
30672, 30690, 30770, 30788,
30850, 31051, 31115, 31151,
31233
31233, 31321
30591, 30675, 30705, 30821,
31268
30591
PRESET CODE
8.AVR2808E2_PresetBack.indd
13
13
2007/09/28
12:59:31
F
Entivo
Enzer
ESA
EuroLine
Fenner
30503, 30539
30784, 30770, 31228
30821, 31268
30675, 30788, 31115, 31233
30651
30651, 30695, 30713, 30884,
30898, 31695, 31730
30672, 30591, 30741, 30751,
30770, 30783
30651, 30713, 30843, 30869,
31530
30670
30675, 30695, 31268
30862
31158
30522, 30815, 30717
30717
31051
31224
30768
31152
30573, 30744, 30717, 30715,
30741, 30783, 30833, 30869,
31044, 31075, 31099, 31158,
31483, 31730
30591, 30741, 30869
30651, 30690, 30713, 30723,
30730, 30783, 30790, 30833,
31004, 31140, 31423, 31530,
31730, 31923
31140
30699, 30741
30490, 30651
30665
30831, 30898
30713, 31233
30717
30539, 30651, 30551, 30670,
30686, 30695, 30705, 30713,
30775, 30790, 31004, 31036,
31695, 31730, 31832, 31920
30770, 30790, 30831
30713, 30841, 30850, 31233,
31421
30751, 31152
30843
30741, 30783, 30790
30582, 30702
30788
30705
30730, 31163, 31923
30713
30843
30573, 30664, 30665, 30713,
31247, 31920
30672, 31923
30651, 30713, 30831, 31004,
31224
Ferguson
Finlux
Firstline
G
Fisher
Funai
Fusion
Gateway
GE
General Electric
Germatic
Global Link
Global Solutions
Global Sphere
Go Video
GoldStar
Goodmans
GP Audio
GPX
Gradiente
Graetz
Gran Prix
Grandin
Greenhill
Grundig
Grunkel
H
H&B
Haaz
Haier
Hanseatic
Harman/Kardon
HCM
HDT
HE
Henss
HiMAX
Hitachi
Hiteker
Hoeher
14
I
J
K
L
Home Electronics
Home Tech Industries
Hoyo
Humax
Hyundai
iLo
Ingelen
Ingersol
Initial
Inno Hit
Insignia
Integra
Irradio
IRT
ISP
Jamo
Jaton
JBL
JDB
JDV
Jeken
Jepssen
JMB
JNC
JSI
30730, 30770
31224
30665
30646
30783, 30850, 31061, 31228
31348
30788
31023
30839, 30717
30713
31268
30571, 30627, 31634
30869, 31115, 31224, 31233
30783
30695
31036
30665
30702
30730
31367
30699
31250
30695
30672, 31271
31423
30503, 30539, 30558, 30623,
JVC
30867, 31164, 31597, 31860
jWin
31051
Kansas Technologies 31233, 31530
Karcher
30783
Kawasaki
30790
Kendo
30672, 30699, 30713, 30831
Kennex
30713, 30770, 30898
Kenwood
30490, 30534
Kiiro
30770
Kiss
30665, 30841, 31523
KLH
30815, 30717, 30790, 31020
Kloss
30533
Koda
31230
Konka
31192
Koss
30651, 31061, 31423
Kreisen
31421
KXD
31321, 31923
Lasonic
30627, 30798, 30789
Lawson
30768
Lecson
31533
Leiker
30872
30651, 30699, 30713, 30770,
Lenco
30774
Lenoir
31228
Lenoxx
30690, 30838
Lexia
30699, 30768
LG
Lifetec
Limit
LiteOn
Lodos
Loewe
Logik
Logix
Luker
Lumatron
M
Lunatron
Luxman
Luxor
Magnasonic
Magnat
Magnavox
Magnex
Majestic
Manhattan
Marantz
Mark
Marquant
Matsui
Maxdorf
Maxent
Maxim
Maya
MBO
McIntosh
MDS
Mecotek
Medion
MEI
Memorex
Metronic
Metz
MiCO
Micromaxx
Micromedia
Micromega
Microsoft
Microstar
Minato
Minax
Minerva
Minoka
Mintek
Mirror
30591, 30741, 30790, 30869,
31906
30651, 30831, 31347
30768, 31104
31058, 31158
30713
30539, 30511, 30741, 30885
30713, 30884
30705, 30783
31367
30695, 30705, 30713, 30741,
30833, 31115, 31321, 31832
30741
30573
30713, 31004, 31695, 31730
30651, 30675
31923
30503, 30539, 30646, 30675,
30713, 30821, 30885, 31140,
31268
30723
31345
30705, 30713
30503, 30539, 30675
30713
30770
30672, 30651, 30695, 30713,
30884, 31004, 31695, 31730
30788
31347
30713, 30872, 31367
31345
30690, 30730, 31730
31533
30713
30770
30651, 30630, 30774, 30783,
30831, 31006, 31270, 31345,
31347, 31423
30790
30690, 30695, 30831, 31270
30690
30525, 30571, 30713
30723, 30751, 31223
31695
30503, 30539
30539, 31005
30522, 31708
30831
30752
30713
30705
30770, 31115
30839, 30717
30752
N
O
Mitsubishi
Mizuda
Monyka
MPX
Mustek
Mx Onda
Mystral
NAD
Naiko
Narita
NEC
Neovia
Nesa
Neufunk
Nevir
NexxTech
Nikkai
Nintaus
Niro
Norcent
Nordmende
Noriko
Nova
Nowa
Nu-Tec
Okano
Olidata
Omni
P
Onix
Onkyo
Oopla
Oppo
Optim
Optimus
Orbit
Orion
Oritron
Ormond
P&B
Pacific
Packard Bell
Palladium
Palsonic
Panasonic
Panda
peeKTon
Philco
Philips
31521, 30521, 30713, 31403
30770, 31451
30665
30843
30730, 31730
30651, 30751, 31223
30831
30741
30770, 31004, 31367
31367
30741, 30869, 31404
31271
30717
30665
30770, 30831, 31197
31402
31923
31051, 31202
32024
30872, 31923
30774, 30831
30752
31923
30843
31228
30752
30672
30690, 30833, 30838, 30862,
31104, 31832
30838
30503, 30627
31158
31224
30843
30525, 30571
30872
30695, 31233, 31695
30651
30713
31451
30695, 30713, 30759, 30768,
30790, 30831
30831
30695, 30713, 31906, 31920
30672, 30852, 31056, 31321
30503, 30490, 30571, 30703,
31362, 31462, 31490, 31579,
31762, 31834, 31905, 31908
30717, 30789, 31203
30898, 31224
30690, 30862
30503, 30539, 30646, 30675,
30854, 30885, 31158, 31260,
31267, 31340, 31354
Philo
Phonotrend
PianoDisc
Pioneer
Plu2
Pointer
Polaroid
Polk Audio
Portland
Powerpoint
Presidian
Prima
Prinz
Prism
Pro2
ProCaster
Proceed
Proline
Proscan
Proson
Prosonic
ProVision
Q
R
Pye
QONIX
Qwestar
Radionette
RadioShack
Raite
RCA
Realistic
REC
Redstar
Relisys
Reoc
Revoy
Rex
Richmond
Rio
Roadstar
S
Rocksonic
Ronin
Rotel
Rowa
Rownsonic
Saba
Sabaki
Saivod
31345
30699
31024
30490, 30525, 30571, 30631,
31965
30850
30784
31020, 31061, 31086
30539
30770
30872, 31005
30675
31228
30831
30705, 30831
31345
31004
30672
30672, 30651, 30686, 30833,
31004, 31483
30522
30713
30699, 30752
30699, 30730, 31163, 31321,
31923
30539, 30646
31051
30651
30741, 30869, 31906, 32024
30571
30665
30522, 30571, 30717, 30790,
30822, 31022, 31132, 31769,
31913, 31965
30571
30490
30759, 30763, 30770, 30788,
30898, 31345, 31923
31347
30752, 30768
30699, 30841
30838
31233
30869
30672, 30690, 30699, 30713,
30730, 30833, 30898, 31051,
31227
30789
30872
30558, 30623
30717, 30759, 30872, 31004
30789
30651, 3055
30798
30759, 30831, 31367
PRESET CODE
8.AVR2808E2_PresetBack.indd
14
2007/09/28
12:59:33
Salora
Sampo
30741
30752, 31321, 31347
30490, 30573, 30744, 30199,
30820, 30899, 31044, 31075,
31635, 31932
30784, 30695, 30751, 30763,
30768, 31051, 31228, 31230,
31695, 31832
30670, 30675, 30695, 30713,
30873, 31228
30705, 30850
30730, 31730
31695
30770, 30788, 31115, 31151
30539, 30646, 30651, 30705,
30713, 30774, 30783, 30788,
30790, 30831, 30869, 31367
30752
30768
30672, 30651, 31005, 31036,
31233, 31423
31224, 31451
30798, 30665, 30713, 30763,
30872, 30884, 31483, 31530
31158
30672
30630, 30675, 30713, 30752,
31256, 32015, 32024
31117
30717, 30741, 30770
30717
30533, 30839
31382
31005, 31224
31224
30788, 30898
30831, 30898
31152
30885
30690, 30751, 30768
30672
30539, 30713
30730, 30768
30898
31115
30784
30690, 30730, 30768, 31152
30705, 30713
30755
30831
30573, 30715, 30783, 30869,
31099
30533, 31533, 30864, 30573,
30630, 30772, 31033, 31070,
31431, 31433, 31536, 31633,
31769, 31981, 32043
31233
30768
Samsung
Sansui
Sanyo
Scan
ScanMagic
ScanSonic
Schaub Lorenz
Schneider
Schwaiger
Scientific Labs
Scott
Seeltech
SEG
Sensory Science
Shanghai
Sharp
Sharper Image
Sherwood
Shinco
Shinsonic
Siemssen
Sigmatek
Siltex
Silva
Silva Schneider
SilverCrest
Simaudio
Singer
Sistemas
Skantic
Skymaster
Skyworth
Sliding
Slim Art
SM Electronic
Smart
Sonai
Sonashi
Sonic Blue
Sony
Sound Color
Soundmaster
Soundmax
Soundwave
Spectra
Standard
T
Star Clusters
Starlogic
Starmedia
Stevison
Strong
Sunkai
Sunstech
Sunwood
Superscan
Supervision
SVA
Sylvania
Symphonic
Synn
Tandberg
Tangent
Targa
Tatung
Tchibo
TCL
TCM
Teac
Tec
Technica
Technics
Technika
Technisson
Technosonic
Techwood
Tedelex
Telefunken
Teletech
Tensai
Tevion
Theta Digital
Thomson
Tivo
Tokai
Tom-Tec
Top Suxess
Toshiba
TRANS-continents
Transonic
30768
30783
30872
30651, 30768, 30788, 30831,
30898
31152, 31227
31005
31005, 31224
31367
30713
30770, 30850
30831
30788, 30898
30821
30768, 31152
30672, 30717, 30752, 31105
30630, 30675, 30821, 31268
30675, 30821, 31268
30768
30713, 31695
31321
31227
30770, 31695
30741
31180
30741, 30790
30571, 30717, 30675, 30741,
30759, 30768, 30790, 30833,
31006, 31197, 31227
30898
31367, 31695
30490, 30703, 31905
30770, 30831, 31115, 31695
31115
30730, 31051, 31115
30713, 31530
30690, 30768, 31004, 31228
30789, 30790, 30833, 31483,
31832, 31923
30713, 30768
30651, 30690, 30770
30651, 30798, 30768, 30833,
30898, 31036, 31227, 31347,
31382, 31483, 31730, 31923
30571
30522, 30511, 30551
31503
30784, 30665, 30788, 30790,
30898
30789
31224
30503, 30573, 30539, 30695,
31045, 31154, 31503, 31510,
31769
30831, 30872, 31321, 31327
30730
U
Tredex
TruVision
Tsinghua Tongfang
TSM
Umax
Unimax
United
Universum
V
W
Uptek
upXus
Urban Concepts
US Logic
Venturer
Vestel
Victor
Vieta
Viewmaster
Voxson
Vtrek
Waitec
Walkvision
Waltham
Welkin
Wellington
Weltstar
Wesder
Wharfedale
X
Y
Wilson
Windsor
Windy Sam
WIZE
Woxter
Xbox
Xenius
XLogic
XMS
Xoro
Yakumo
Yamada
Yamaha
Yamakawa
Yukai
Z
Zenith
Zeus
30843
31451
31205
31224
30690, 31151
30770
30675, 30695, 30699, 30713,
30730, 30788, 30884, 31115,
31152, 31228, 31367, 31832
30591, 30713, 30741, 30790,
30869, 31227, 31530, 31913
30763
31345
30503, 30539
30839
30790
30713, 30884, 31530
31597
30705
30862, 31224
30690, 30730, 30774, 30831
31228
31151, 31224, 31233
30717
31530
30831
30713
30713
30699
30686, 30751, 30752, 30790,
31832
30831, 31233
30713
30573
31115
31005, 31151, 31224
30522, 31708
30790
30768, 31152, 31228
30770, 30788
31183, 31250
31004, 31056
30872, 31004, 31056, 31151,
31158
30490, 30539, 30646, 30545,
31354
30665, 30872, 31104
30730, 31730
30503, 30591, 30741, 30869,
31906
30784
DVD Recorder
1
4Kus
31158
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
Airis
Akira
Alba
Apex Digital
Aristona
Aspire Digital
Belson
Cat
cello
Centrum
Classic
Coby
Commax
Conia
CyberHome
Cytron
Denon
Denver
Digitrex
DSE
Durabrand
E:max
Ellion
Eltax
Emerson
Ferguson
Firstline
Funai
Gateway
Go Video
Goodmans
GPX
Grundig
H&B
Humax
iLo
JVC
Kansas Technologies
Kreisen
KXD
LG
Lifetec
LiteOn
Loewe
Lumatron
Luxor
Magnavox
Matsui
Maxent
MBO
Medion
MiCO
31321
31321
31530
31056
30646
31168
31086
31421
31730
31227
31730
31086
31321
31321
31129, 31502
31347
30490
31056
31056
31730
31502
31321
31421
31321
30675
31730
31530
30675
31158
30741, 31158, 31730
31530, 31730
30741
31730
31421
30646
31348
31164, 31597
31530
31421
31321
30741
31347
31158
30741
31321
31730
30646, 30675
31730
31347
31730
31347
30751
N
O
P
R
S
Mitsubishi
Mustek
NEC
Oopla
Palsonic
Panasonic
Philips
Pioneer
Polaroid
ProVision
Pye
RCA
Relisys
Roadstar
Sampo
Samsung
ScanMagic
Schneider
SEG
Sensory Science
Sharp
Sony
T
U
V
W
Y
Z
Star Clusters
Sylvania
Tangent
Targa
Teac
Techwood
Tevion
Thomson
Toshiba
Universum
Vestel
Victor
Waltham
Yakumo
Yamada
Yamaha
Yukai
Zenith
31403
31730
31404
31158
31056, 31321
30490, 31579
30646, 31158
30631
31086
31321
30646
30522
31347
31227
31347
30490, 31635
31730
30646
31530
31158
30630, 30675
31033, 31070, 31431, 31433,
31536
31227
30675
31321
31227
31227
31530
31227, 31347, 31730
30551
31510
31227, 31530
31530
31597
31530
31056
31056, 31158
30646
31730
30741
PRESET CODE
8.AVR2808E2_PresetBack.indd
15
15
2007/09/28
12:59:34
DVD preset codes
DVD-Voreinstellungscodes
Codes préréglés DVD
Codici di preselezione DVD
Códigos de preajuste de DVD
DVD-voorkeuzecodes
Förinställda DVD-koder
e
Model No.
Modellnr
Modéle numéro
Modello No
Nº de modelo
Modelnr
Modellnr
[
[
[
[
[
[
[
]z:
]z:
]z:
]z:
]z:
]z:
]z:
16
32134
DVD-550
DVD-700
DVD-900
DVD-1000
DVD-1400
DVD-1500
DVD-1710
DVD-1910
DVD-1930
DVD-2200
DVD-2800
DVD-2800g
DVD-2900
DVD-2910
DVD-2930
DVD-3800
DVD-3910
DVD-3930
DVD-A11
DVD-A1
DVD-A1XV
30490
DVD-800
DVD-1600
DVD-2000
DVD-2500
DVD-3000
DVD-3300
Preset codes set upon shipment from the factory.
Sie Voreinstellungscodes wurden vor der Auslieferung werkseitig eingestellt.
Les codes préréglés diffèrent en fonctiom des livraison de l’usine.
I codici di presettaggio sono impostati in fabbrica prima della consegna.
Los códigos vienen preprogramados de fábrica.
Vooringestelde codes bij hey verlaten van de fabriek.
Förinställda koder har ställts in vid transporten från fabriken.
b1 :These preset codes can be recorded in the SAT/CBL mode.
b1 :Diese voreingestellten Codes können im SAT/CBL-Modus aufgenommen werden.
b1 :Ces codes de présélection peuvent être enregistrés en mode SAT/CBL.
b1 :I codici preimpostati possono essere registrati nel modo SAT/CBL.
b1 :Es posible guardar estos códigos preajustados en el modo SAT/CBL.
b1 :Deze voorkeuzecodes kunnen worden opgenomen in de SAT/CBL-modus.
b1 :Dessa förinställningskoder kan lagras i SAT/CBL-läget.
b2 :These preset codes can be recorded in the TV mode.
b1 :Diese voreingestellten Codes können im TV-Modus aufgenommen werden.
b1 :Ces codes de présélection peuvent être enregistrés en mode TV.
b1 :I codici preimpostati possono essere registrati nel modo TV.
b1 :Es posible guardar estos códigos preajustados en el modo TV.
b1 :Deze voorkeuzecodes kunnen worden opgenomen in de TV-modus.
b1 :Dessa förinställningskoder kan lagras i TV-läget.
b3 :These preset codes can be recorded in the VCR mode.
b1 :Diese voreingestellten Codes können im VCR-Modus aufgenommen werden.
b1 :Ces codes de présélection peuvent être enregistrés en mode VCR.
b1 :I codici preimpostati possono essere registrati nel modo VCR.
b1 :Es posible guardar estos códigos preajustados en el modo VCR.
b1 :Deze voorkeuzecodes kunnen worden opgenomen in de VCR-modus.
b1 :Dessa förinställningskoder kan lagras i VCR-läget.
b4 :These preset codes can be recorded in the DVD mode.
b1 :Diese voreingestellten Codes können im DVD-Modus aufgenommen werden.
b1 :Ces codes de présélection peuvent être enregistrés en mode DVD.
b1 :I codici preimpostati possono essere registrati nel modo DVD.
b1 :Es posible guardar estos códigos preajustados en el modo DVD.
b1 :Deze voorkeuzecodes kunnen worden opgenomen in de DVD-modus.
b1 :Dessa förinställningskoder kan lagras i DVD-läget.
PRESET CODE
8.AVR2808E2_PresetBack.indd
16
2007/09/28
12:59:35
8.AVR2808E2_PresetBack.indd
17
2007/09/28
12:59:35
8.AVR2808E2_PresetBack.indd
18
2007/09/28
12:59:35
8.AVR2808E2_PresetBack.indd
19
2007/09/28
12:59:35
www.denon.com
Denon Brand Company, D&M Holdings Inc.
Printed in China 00D 511 4733 103
8.AVR2808E2_PresetBack.indd
20
2007/09/28
12:59:35